Você está na página 1de 286

VOLVO S40

Owner's manual Web Edition

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
Welcome to the world-wide family of Volvo owners. We trust
that you will enjoy many years of safe driving in your Volvo, an
automobile designed with your safety and comfort in mind. We
encourage you to familiarize yourself with the equipment
descriptions and operating instructions in this manual. We also
urge you and your passengers to wear seat belts at all times in
this (or any other) vehicle. And, of course, please do not operate
a vehicle if you may be affected by alcohol, medication or any
impairment that could hinder your ability to drive.
Your Volvo is designed to meet all applicable safety and emis-
sion standards. For further information please contact your
retailer, or:
In the USA: Volvo Cars of North America, LLC Customer Care
Center
P.O. Box 914
Rockleigh, New Jersey 07647-0914
1-800-458-1552
www.volvocars.us
In Canada: Volvo Cars of Canada Corp
National Customer Service
175 Gordon Baker Road
North York, Ontario M2H 2N7
1-800-663-8255
www.volvocanada.com
2008 Volvo Car Corporation, All rights reserved.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
Contents

00 Introduction 01 Safety 02 Instruments and controls


General information.................................. 10 Occupant safety........................................ 16 Instrument overview.................................. 50
Volvo and the environment....................... 12 Seat belts.................................................. 18 Instrument panel....................................... 53
Important warnings................................... 13 Supplemental Restraint System............... 21 Indicator and warning symbols................. 55
Occupant Weight Sensor (OWS).............. 26 Symbols instrument panel..................... 57

00 01 02
Side impact protection airbags................. 29 Information display................................... 60
Volvo Inflatable Curtain (VIC).................... 30 12-volt sockets......................................... 62
Whiplash Protection System..................... 32 Lighting panel........................................... 63
Crash mode.............................................. 34 Left-side steering wheel lever................... 66
Child safety............................................... 35 Trip computer........................................... 68
Child restraint systems............................. 37 Cruise control (option)............................... 70
Infant seats............................................... 38 Right-side steering wheel lever................. 72
Convertible seats...................................... 40 Steering wheel adjustment, Hazard warn-
Booster cushions...................................... 42 ing flashers................................................ 74
ISOFIX lower anchors............................... 43 Parking brake............................................ 75
Top tether anchors.................................... 45 Power windows......................................... 76
Child restraint registration and recalls...... 46 Mirrors....................................................... 78
Power moonroof (option).......................... 81
Personal settings...................................... 83
HomeLink Wireless Control System
(option)...................................................... 86

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

4
Contents

03 Climate 04 Interior 05 Locks and alarm


General information.................................. 92 Front seats.............................................. 104 Remote control and key blade................ 118
Air vents.................................................... 94 Interior lighting........................................ 107 Valet locking ........................................... 122
Manual climate control.............................. 95 Storage compartments........................... 109 Keyless drive (option as available).......... 123
Electronic Climate Control (ECC) Rear seat................................................. 113 Locking and unlocking............................ 127

03 04 05
option........................................................ 98 Trunk ...................................................... 115 Child safety locks.................................... 129
Air distribution......................................... 101 Alarm (option).......................................... 130

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

5
Contents

06 Starting and driving 07 Wheels and tires 08 Car care


General information................................ 136 General information................................ 174 Washing and cleaning the car................. 202
Fuel requirements................................... 140 Tire inflation............................................. 176 Paint touch up......................................... 206
Ignition switch......................................... 143 Inflation pressureU.S. models ............ 178
Starting the vehicle................................. 144 Inflation pressureCanadian models .... 179

06 07 08
Starting the vehicle with keyless drive Tire designations..................................... 180
(option as available)................................ 146 Glossary of tire terminology.................... 182
Manual transmission, 5-speed (certain Vehicle loading........................................ 183
markets only)........................................... 147
Uniform tire quality gradings................... 185
Manual transmission, 6-speed (certain
markets only)........................................... 148 Snow chains, snow tires, studded tires. . 186
Automatic transmission (option)............. 149 Temporary spare..................................... 187
Shiftlock override.................................... 151 Wheel nuts.............................................. 188
All Wheel Drive (option)........................... 152 Tire rotation............................................. 189
Brake system.......................................... 153 Changing a wheel................................... 190
Stability system....................................... 155 Tire Sealing System ............................... 192
Towing.................................................... 157 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) 197
Jump starting.......................................... 159
Towing a trailer....................................... 160
Detachable trailer hitch........................... 162
Transporting loads.................................. 163
Blind Spot Information System (BLIS)
option...................................................... 164
Park assist (Option/accessory)............... 168

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

6
Contents

09 Maintenance and servicing 10 Audio 11 Specifications


Volvo maintenance.................................. 210 Audio functions....................................... 240 Label information.................................... 262
Maintaining your car............................... 212 Radio functions....................................... 244 Dimensions and weights......................... 264
Hood....................................................... 214 CD player/CD changer............................ 249 Fuel, oils, and fluids................................ 267
Engine compartment............................... 215 Audio menu............................................. 253 Engine oil................................................ 269

09 10 11
Engine oil................................................ 216 Bluetooth hands-free connection......... 254 Engine specifications.............................. 270
Fluids....................................................... 218 Electrical system..................................... 272
Wiper blades........................................... 220 Three-way catalytic converter................. 274
Battery..................................................... 221 Volvo programs....................................... 275
Replacing bulbs...................................... 223
Fuses....................................................... 230

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

7
Contents

12 Index
Index....................................................... 276

12
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

8
Contents

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

9
Introduction

General information

Shiftlock (automatic transmission) Indicator Lamp ("Check Engine" light) may NOTE
When your car is parked, the gear selector is indicate a fault.
locked in the Park (P) position. To release the Optional or accessory equipment
selector from this position, turn the ignition key About this manual described in this manual may not be
Before you operate your vehicle for the first available in all countries or markets.
to position II (or start the engine), depress the
time, please familiarize yourself with the Please note that some vehicles may be
brake pedal, press the button on the front side
new-engine oil consumption information, equipped differently, depending on
of the gear selector and move the selector from
see page 216. You should also be familiar special legal requirements.
Park (P).
with the information found in the chapters All information, illustrations and specifi-
Keylock (automatic transmission) "Instruments and controls", and "Starting cations contained in this manual are
When the ignition is switched off, the gear and driving". based on the latest product information
selector must be in the Park (P) position before Information contained in the balance of the available at the time of publication.
the key can be removed from the ignition manual is extremely useful and should be Volvo reserves the right to make model
switch. read after operating the vehicle for the first changes at any time, or to change spec-
time. ifications or design without notice and
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) The manual is structured so that it can be without incurring obligation.
The ABS system in your car performs a self- used for reference. For this reason, it
diagnostic test when the vehicle first reaches
Do not export your Volvo to another
should be kept in the vehicle for ready country before investigating that coun-
the speed of approximately 12 mph access. try's applicable safety and emission
(20 km/h). The brake pedal will pulsate several control requirements. In some cases it
times and a sound may be audible from the may be difficult or impossible to comply
ABS control module. This is normal. with these requirements. Modifications
to the emission control system(s) may
Fuel filler door render your Volvo not certifiable for
Press the button on the light switch panel when legal operation in the U.S., Canada and
the car is at a standstill to open the fuel filler other countries.
door.

Fuel filler cap


After refueling, close the fuel filler cap by turn-
ing it clockwise until it clicks into place. If this
cap is not closed tightly or if the engine is run-
ning when the car is refueled, the Malfunction

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

10
Introduction

General information

WARNING
If your vehicle is involved in an accident,
unseen damage may affect its driveability
and safety.

WARNING
CALIFORNIA proposition 65
Engine exhaust, some of its constituents,
and certain vehicle components contain or
emit chemicals known to the state of Cali-
fornia to cause cancer, and birth defects or
other reproductive harm. In addition, certain
fluids contained in vehicles and certain
products of component wear contain or
emit chemicals known to the State of Cali-
fornia to cause cancer, and birth defects or
other reproductive harm.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

11
Introduction

Volvo and the environment

Volvo is committed to the well being of its cus- is the next critical step in completing the life cator) light illuminates, or stays on after the
tomers. As a natural part of this commitment, cycle. The metal content is about 75% of the vehicle has started.
we care about the environment in which we all total weight of a vehicle, which makes the vehi- Properly dispose of any vehicle-related
live. Caring for the environment means an cle among the most recycled industrial prod- waste such as used motor oil, used batter-
everyday involvement in reducing our environ- ucts. In order to have efficient and well- ies, brake pads, etc.
mental impact. Volvo's environmental activities controlled recycling, dismantling information is
When cleaning your vehicle, please use
are based on a holistic view, which means we available for all Volvo models. For Volvo, all genuine Volvo car care products. All Volvo
consider the overall environmental impact of a homogeneous plastic parts weighing more car care products are formulated to be
product throughout its complete life cycle. In than 3.4 oz. (100 grams) are marked with inter- environmentally friendly.
this context, design, production, product use, national symbols that indicate how the com-
For additional information regarding the envi-
and recycling are all important considerations. ponent is to be sorted for recycling. In addition
ronmental activities in which Volvo Cars of
In production, Volvo has partly or completely to continuous environmental refinement of
North America, LLC and Volvo Car Corporation
phased out several chemicals including CFCs, conventional gasoline-powered internal com-
are involved, visit our Internet home page at:
lead chromates, asbestos, and cadmium; and bustion engines, Volvo is actively looking at
http://www.volvocars.us.
reduced the number of chemicals used in our advanced technology alternative-fuel vehicles.
plants 50% since 1991.
When you drive a Volvo, you become our part- WARNING
Volvo was the first in the world to introduce into ner in the work to lessen the car's impact on
production a three-way catalytic converter with the environment. To reduce your vehicle's Certain components of this vehicle such as
a Lambda sond, now called the heated oxygen environmental impact, you can: air bag modules, seat belt pretensioners,
adaptive steering columns, and button cell
sensor, in 1976. The current version of this
highly efficient system reduces emissions of
Maintain proper air pressure in your tires. batteries may contain Perchlorate material.
Tests have shown decreased fuel econ- Special handling may apply for service or
harmful substances (CO, HC, NOx) from the omy with improperly inflated tires. vehicle end of life disposal.
exhaust pipe by approximately 95 99% and
Follow the recommended maintenance See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/
the search to eliminate the remaining emis- perchlorate.
schedule in your Warranty and Service
sions continues. Volvo is the only automobile
Records Information booklet.
manufacturer to offer CFC-free retrofit kits for
the air conditioning system of all models as far Drive at a constant speed whenever pos-
back as the 1975 model 240. Advanced elec- sible.
tronic engine controls and cleaner fuels are See a trained and qualified Volvo service
bringing us closer to our goal. After Volvo vehi- technician as soon as possible for inspec-
cles and parts have fulfilled their use, recycling tion if the check engine (malfunction indi-

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

12
Introduction

Important warnings

Accessory Installation Information booklet for more warranty cellular telephone use by a driver while the
We strongly recommend that Volvo owners information. Volvo assumes no responsi- vehicle is moving.
install only genuine, Volvo-approved bility for death, injury, or expenses that If your vehicle is equipped with a naviga-
accessories, and that accessory installa- may result from the installation of nonge- tion system, set and make changes to your
tions be performed only by a trained and nuine accessories. travel itinerary only with the vehicle parked.
qualified Volvo service technician. Never program your audio system while
Genuine Volvo accessories are tested to Driver distraction the vehicle is moving. Program radio pre-
ensure compatibility with the performance, Driver distraction results from driver activ- sets with the vehicle parked, and use your
safety, and emission systems in your vehi- ities that are not directly related to control- programmed presets to make radio use
cle. Additionally, a trained and qualified ling the vehicle in the driving environment. quicker and simpler.
Volvo service technician knows where Your new Volvo is, or can be, equipped Never use portable computers or personal
accessories may and may not be safely with many feature-rich entertainment and digital assistants while the vehicle is mov-
installed in your Volvo. In all cases, please communication systems. These include ing.
consult a trained and qualified Volvo serv- hands-free cellular telephones, navigation
ice technician before installing any acces- systems, and multipurpose audio systems. A driver has a responsibility to do everything
sory in or on your vehicle. You may also own other portable elec- possible to ensure his or her own safety and
tronic devices for your own convenience. the safety of passengers in the vehicle and oth-
Accessories that have not been approved
ers sharing the roadway. Avoiding distractions
by Volvo may or may not be specifically When used properly and safely, they enrich
the driving experience. Improperly used, is part of that responsibility.
tested for compatibility with your vehicle.
Additionally, an inexperienced installer any of these could cause a distraction.
may not be familiar with some of your vehi- For all of these systems, we want to pro-
cle's systems. vide the following warning that reflects the
Any of your vehicle's performance and strong Volvo concern for your safety:
safety systems could be adversely affec- Never use these devices or any feature of
ted if you install accessories that Volvo has your vehicle in a way that distracts you
not tested, or if you allow accessories to be from the task of driving safely. Distraction
installed by someone unfamiliar with your can lead to a serious accident. In addition
vehicle. to this general warning, we offer the fol-
Damage caused by unapproved or lowing guidance regarding specific newer
improperly installed accessories may not features that may be found in your vehicle:
be covered by your new vehicle warranty. Never use a hand-held cellular telephone
See your Warranty and Service Records while driving. Some jurisdictions prohibit

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

13
Occupant safety...................................................................................... 16
Seat belts................................................................................................ 18
Supplemental Restraint System.............................................................. 21
Occupant Weight Sensor (OWS)............................................................. 26
Side impact protection airbags............................................................... 29
Volvo Inflatable Curtain (VIC).................................................................. 30
Whiplash Protection System................................................................... 32
Crash mode............................................................................................. 34
Child safety............................................................................................. 35
Child restraint systems........................................................................... 37
Infant seats.............................................................................................. 38
Convertible seats.................................................................................... 40
Booster cushions.................................................................................... 42
ISOFIX lower anchors............................................................................. 43
Top tether anchors.................................................................................. 45

G020871
Child restraint registration and recalls.................................................... 46

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

14
SAFETY

01
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
01 Safety

01 Occupant safety

Volvo's concern for safety Never drink and drive. However, NHTSA cannot become
Safety is Volvo's cornerstone. Our concern If you are taking any medication, consult involved in individual problems
dates back to 1927 when the first Volvo rolled your physician about its potential effects between you, your retailer, or Volvo
off the production line. Three-point seat belts on your driving abilities.
(a Volvo invention), safety cages, and energy-
Cars of North America, LLC.
Take a driver-retraining course.
absorbing impact zones were designed into To contact NHTSA, you may either
Volvo cars long before it was fashionable or
Have your eyes checked regularly.
Keep your windshield and headlights call the Auto Safety Hotline toll-free at
required by government regulation.
clean. 1-888-327-4236
We will not compromise our commitment to
safety. We continue to seek out new safety
Replace wiper blades when they start to
leave streaks. (TTY: 1-800-424-9153) or write to:
features and to refine those already in our cars.
You can help. We would appreciate hearing Take into account the traffic, road, and NHTSA, U.S. Department of Trans-
your suggestions about improving automobile weather conditions, particularly with portation, Washington D.C. 20590.
safety. We also want to know if you ever have regard to stopping distance.
You can also obtain other information
a safety concern with your car. Call us in the
U.S. at: 1-800-458-1552 or in Canada at: Reporting safety defects in the U.S.
about motor vehicle safety from:
1-800-663-8255. If you believe that your vehicle has a http://www.safercar.gov
defect which could cause a crash or Volvo strongly recommends that if your vehicle
Occupant safety reminders could cause injury or death, you is covered under a service campaign, safety or
How safely you drive doesn't depend on how emission recall or similar action, it should be
should immediately inform the
old you are but rather on: completed as soon as possible. Please check
National Highway Traffic Safety with your local retailer or Volvo Cars of North
How well you see.
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to America, LLC if your vehicle is covered under
Your ability to concentrate. notifying Volvo Cars of North Amer- these conditions.
How quickly you make decisions under ica, LLC. If NHTSA receives similar NHTSA can be reached at:
stress to avoid an accident.
complaints, it may open an investiga- Internet:
The following suggestions are intended to help
tion, and if it finds that a safety defect
you cope with the ever changing trafficenvir- http://www.nhtsa.gov
onment. exists in a group of vehicles, it may
order a recall and remedy campaign. Telephone:

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

16
01 Safety

Occupant safety 01

1-888-DASH-2-DOT (1-888-327-4236).

Reporting safety defects in Canada


If you believe your vehicle has a defect that
could cause a crash or could cause injury or
death, you should immediately inform Trans-
port Canada in addition to notifying Volvo Cars
of Canada Corp.
To contact Transport Canada, call (800)
333-0510, or (613) 993-9851 if you are calling
from the Ottawa region.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

17
01 Safety

01 Seat belts

Using seat belts certain impacts from the rear. The front seat retracts fully after being unbuckled. If nec-
belts also include a tension reducing device essary, guide the belt back into the retrac-
which, in the event of a collision, limits the peak tor slot.
forces exerted by the seat belt on the occu-
pant. WARNING
Buckling a seat belt Never use a seat belt for more than one
occupant. Never wear the shoulder portion
Pull the belt out far enough to insert the latch
of the belt under the arm, behind the back
plate into the receptacle until a distinct click is or otherwise out of position. Such use could
heard. The seat belt retractor is normally cause injury in the event of an accident. As
"unlocked" and you can move freely, provided seat belts lose much of their strength when
that the shoulder belt is not pulled out too far. exposed to violent stretching, they should
be replaced after any collision, even if they
G020104 The retractor will lock up as follows: appear to be undamaged.
if the belt is pulled out rapidly
during braking and acceleration
Adjusting the seat belt
if the vehicle is leaning excessively
Seat belts should always be worn by all occu-
when driving in turns
pants of your vehicle. Children should be prop-
erly restrained, using an infant, car, or booster When wearing the seat belt remember:
seat determined by age, weight and height. The belt should not be twisted or turned.
Volvo also believes no child should sit in the The lap section of the belt must be posi-
front seat of a vehicle. tioned low on the hips (not pressing against
the abdomen).
Most states and provinces make it mandatory
for occupants of a vehicle to use seat belts. Make sure that the shoulder belt is rolled
up into its retractor and that the shoulder
Seat belt pretensioners and lap belts are taut.
The outboard seat belts are equipped with pre-
Unbuckling the seat belt
tensioners that reduce slack in the belts. These
pretensioners are triggered in situations where To remove the seat belt, press the red sec-
tion on the seat belt receptacle. Before
the front or side impact airbags deploy, and in
exiting the vehicle, check that the seat belt

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

18
01 Safety

Seat belts 01

WARNING Seat belt use during pregnancy steering wheel). Within this context, they
should strive to position the seat with as large
Never repair the belt yourself; have this a distance as possible between their belly and
work done by a trained and qualified the steering wheel.
Volvo service technician only.
Any device used to induce slack into the
Child seats
shoulder belt portion of the three-point
belt system will have a detrimental Please refer to page 37 for information on
effect on the amount of protection avail- securing child seats with the seat belts.
able to you in the event of a collision.
The seat back should not be tilted too Seat belt reminder
far back. The shoulder belt must be taut
in order to function properly.

G020105
Do not use child safety seats or child
booster cushions/backrests in the front
passenger's seat. We also recommend
that children who have outgrown these The seat belt should always be worn during
devices sit in the rear seat with the seat pregnancy. But it is crucial that it be worn in the
belt properly fastened. correct way. The diagonal section should wrap
over the shoulder then be routed between the
breasts and to the side of the belly. The lap
section should lay flat over the thighs and as
low as possible under the belly. It must never

G018084
be allowed to ride upward. Remove all slack
from the belt and insure that it fits close to the
body without any twists.
Seat belt reminder light in ceiling console
As a pregnancy progresses, pregnant drivers The seat belt reminder consists of an audible
should adjust their seats and steering wheel signal, an indicator light near the rearview mir-
such that they can easily maintain control of the ror and a symbol in the instrument panel that
vehicle as they drive (which means they must alert all occupants of the vehicle if their seat
be able to easily operate the foot pedals and

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

19
01 Safety

01 Seat belts

belts are not fastened. These signals will last Seat belt maintenance
for approximately 6 seconds. Check periodically that the seat belts are in
good condition. Use water and a mild deter-
Rear seats
gent for cleaning. Check seat belt mechanism
The seat belt reminder in the rear seat has two
function as follows: attach the seat belt and pull
additional functions:
rapidly on the strap.
It provides information about which seat
belts are fastened in the rear seat. A mes-
sage will appear in the information display
when a belt is being used or if one of the
rear doors has been opened. This message
will disappear after approximately 30 sec-
onds or can be erased by pressing the
READ button on the left steering wheel
lever.
It also provides a reminder if one of the
occupants of the rear seat has unbuckled
his/her seat belt while the vehicle is in
motion. A visual and audible signal will be
given. These signals will stop when the
seat belt has been re-buckled or can be
stopped by pressing the READ button.
The message in the information display can
always be accessed, even if it has been erased,
by pressing the READ button to display stored
messages.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

20
01 Safety

Supplemental Restraint System 01

Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Where applicable, a text message will also be WARNING
displayed when the SRS warning light illumi-
nates. If this warning symbol is not functioning If your vehicle has been subjected to flood
properly, the general warning symbol conditions (e.g. soaked carpeting/standing
water on the floor of the vehicle) or if your
vehicle has become flood-damaged in any
way, do not attempt to start the vehicle or
put the key in the ignition before discon-
illuminates and either SRS AIRBAG necting the battery (see below). This may
SERVICE URGENT or SRS AIRBAG cause airbag deployment which could result
SERVICE REQUIRED will be displayed. in personal injury. Have the vehicle towed to
a trained and qualified Volvo service tech-
nician for repairs.
WARNING
Automatic transmission
If the SRS warning light stays on after
G026330

Before attempting to tow the vehicle, use


the engine has started or if it illuminates
the following procedure to override the
while you are driving, have the vehicle shiftlock system to move the gear selector
SRS warning light inspected by a trained and qualified to the neutral position:
Volvo service technician as soon as
As an enhancement to the three-point seat possible. 1. Switch off the ignition for at least
belts, your Volvo is equipped with a Supple- 10 minutes and disconnect the battery.
mental Restraint System (SRS). Volvo's SRS Never try to repair any component or
part of the SRS yourself. Any interfer- 2. Wait at least one minute.
consists of seat belt pretensioners, front air-
bags, side impact airbags, the occupant ence in the system could cause mal- 3. Insert the key in the ignition and turn it
function and serious injury. All work on to position II.
weight sensor, and inflatable curtains. All of
these systems should be performed by 4. Press firmly on the brake pedal.
these systems are monitored by the SRS con-
a trained and qualified Volvo service
trol module. An SRS warning light in the instru- 5. Move the gear selector from Park (P) to
technician.
ment panel (see the illustration) illuminates the Neutral (N) position, see page 151,
when the ignition key is turned to position I, II, for information on manually overriding
or III, and will normally go out after approxi- the shiftlock system.
mately 7 seconds if no faults are detected in
the system.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

21
01 Safety

01 Supplemental Restraint System

The front airbag system The driver's side front airbag is folded and
located in the steering wheel hub.
The passenger's side front airbag is folded
behind a panel located above the glove
compartment.

G020111

G015167
The front airbags supplement the three-point Location of the passenger's side front airbag
seat belts. For these airbags to provide the As the movement of the seats' occupants com-
protection intended, seat belts must be worn presses the airbags, some of the gas is expel-
at all times. led at a controlled rate to provide better
The front airbag system includes gas genera- cushioning. Both seat belt pretensioners also
tors surrounded by the airbags, and decelera- deploy, minimizing seat belt slack. The entire
tion sensors that activate the gas generators, process, including inflation and deflation of the
causing the airbags to be inflated with nitrogen airbags, takes approximately one fifth of a sec-
gas. ond.
The location of the front airbags is indicated by
SRS AIRBAG embossed on the steering wheel
pad and above the glove compartment, and by
decals on both sun visors and on the front and
far right side of the dash.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

22
01 Safety

Supplemental Restraint System 01

WARNING Front airbag deployment NOTE


The front airbags are designed to deploy
The airbags in the vehicle are designed
during certain frontal or front-angular col- Deployment of front airbags occurs only
to be a SUPPLEMENT to-not a replace- one time during an accident. In a colli-
lisions, impacts, or decelerations, depend-
ment for-the three-point seat belts. For sion where deployment occurs, the air-
ing on the crash severity, angle, speed and
maximum protection, wear seat belts at bags and seat belt pretensioners acti-
object impacted. The airbags may also
all times. Be aware that no system can vate. Some noise occurs and a small
deploy in certain non-frontal collisions
prevent all possible injuries that may amount of powder is released. The
where rapid deceleration occurs.
occur in an accident. release of the powder may appear as
The SRS sensors, which trigger the front smoke-like matter. This is a normal
Never drive a vehicle with a steering
airbags, are designed to react to both the
wheel-mounted airbag with your hands characteristic and does not indicate fire.
impact of the collision and the inertial
on the steering wheel pad/airbag hous-
forces generated by it, and to determine if Volvo's front airbags use special sen-
ing. sors that are integrated with the front
the intensity of the collision is sufficient for
The front airbags are designed to help seat buckles. The point at which the air-
the seat belt pretensioners and/or airbags
prevent serious injury. Deployment bag deploys is determined by whether
to be deployed.
occurs very quickly and with consider- or not the seat belt is being used, as well
However, not all frontal collisions activate the as the severity of the collision.
able force. During normal deployment
front airbags.
and depending on variables such as Collisions can occur where only one of
seating position, one may experience If the collision involves a nonrigid object the airbags deploys. If the impact is less
abrasions, bruises, swellings, or other (e.g., a snow drift or bush), or a rigid, fixed severe, but severe enough to present a
injuries as a result from deployment of object at a low speed, the front airbags will clear injury risk, the airbags are trig-
one or both of the airbags. not necessarily deploy. gered at partial capacity. If the impact is
When installing any accessory equip- Front airbags do not normally deploy in a more severe, the airbags are triggered
ment, make sure that the front airbag side impact collision, in a collision from the at full capacity.
system is not damaged. Any interfer- rear or in a rollover situation.
ence in the system could cause mal- The amount of damage to the bodywork Should you have questions about any compo-
function. does not reliably indicate if the airbags nent in the SRS system, please contact a
should have deployed or not. trained and qualified Volvo service technician
or Volvo Customer Support:
In the USA
Volvo Cars of North America, LLC

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

23
01 Safety

01 Supplemental Restraint System

Customer Care Center WARNING


P.O. Box 914 Rockleigh, New Jersey Do not use child safety seats or child
07647-0914 booster cushions/backrests in the front
1-800-458-1552 passenger's seat. We also recommend
that occupants under 4 feet 7 inches
www.volvocars.us (140 cm) in height who have outgrown
In Canada these devices sit in the rear seat with the
seat belt fastened1.
Volvo Cars of Canada Corp.
Never drive with the airbags deployed.
National Customer Service The fact that they hang out can impair
175 Gordon Baker Road the steering of your vehicle. Other

G032243
safety systems can also be damaged.
North York, Ontario M2H 2N7
The smoke and dust formed when the
1-800-663-8255 airbags are deployed can cause skin
Airbag decal in the front passenger's door opening
and eye irritation in the event of pro-
www.volvocanada.com longed exposure.

1 See also the Occupant Weight Sensor information on page 26.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

24
01 Safety

Supplemental Restraint System 01

WARNING WARNING
Children must never be allowed in the No objects or accessory equipment,
front passenger's seat. Volvo recom- e.g. dashboard covers, may be placed
mends that ALL occupants (adults and on, attached to, or installed near the air
children) shorter than 4 feet 7 inches bag hatch (the area above the glove
(140 cm) be seated in the back seat of compartment) or the area affected by
any vehicle with a passenger-side front airbag deployment.
airbag. See page 36 for guidelines. There should be no loose articles, e.g.
Occupants in the front passenger's seat coffee cups, on the floor, seat, or dash-
must never sit on the edge of the seat, board area.
sit leaning toward the instrument panel Never try to open the airbag cover on
G032525
or otherwise sit out of position. the steering wheel or the passenger's
The occupant's back must be as upright side dashboard. This should only be
as comfort allows and be against the done by a trained and qualified Volvo
Airbag decal on passenger's side dashboard seat back with the seat belt properly service technician.
fastened. Failure to follow these instructions can
Feet must be on the floor, e.g., not on result in injury to the vehicle occupants.
the dash, seat or out of the window.
G032934

Airbag decal on the outside of both sun visors

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

25
01 Safety

01 Occupant Weight Sensor (OWS)

Disabling the passenger's side front not inflate) the passenger's side front airbag The OWS uses a PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
airbag under certain conditions. indicator lamp which will illuminate and stay on
to remind you that the passenger's side front
The OWS works with sensors that are part of
airbag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIRBAG
the front passenger's seat and seat belt. The
OFF indicator lamp is located in the overhead
sensors are designed to detect the presence of
2 console, near the base of the rearview mirror.
a properly seated occupant and determine if
the passenger's side front airbag should be
enabled (may inflate) or disabled (will not NOTE
inflate). When the ignition is switched on, the OWS
The OWS will disable (will not inflate) the pas- indicator light will go on for up to 10 seconds
while the system performs a self-diagnostic
senger's side front airbag when: test.
the front passenger's seat is unoccupied,
or has small/medium objects in the front However, if a fault is detected in the system:
G018082

seat,
the system determines that an infant is The OWS indicator light will stay on

Occupant Weight Sensor (OWS) indicator light present in a rear-facing infant seat that is The SRS warning light (see page 21) will
installed according to the manufacturer's come on and stay on
Volvo recommends that ALL occupants (adults instructions, The message PASS. AIRBAG OFF SERVICE
and children) shorter than 4 feet 7 inches
(140 cm) be seated in the rear seat of any vehi- the system determines that a small child is URGENT will be displayed in the information
present in a forward-facing child restraint display.
cle with a passenger's side front airbag, and be
that is installed according to the manufac-
properly restrained. Children should always be turer's instructions,
seated in child restraints appropriate for their
size and weight. See also the child safety rec- the system determines that a small child is
ommendations on page 35. present in a booster seat,

The Occupant Weight Sensor (OWS) is


a front passenger takes his/her weight off
of the seat for a period of time,
designed to meet the regulatory requirements
of Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard a child or a small person occupies the front
(FMVSS) 208 and is designed to disable (will passenger's seat.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

26
01 Safety

Occupant Weight Sensor (OWS) 01

WARNING passenger's side front airbag is disabled (see system senses that a person of adult size is
the following table). sitting properly in the front passenger's seat.
If a fault in the system is detected and indi- The PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
cated as explained on the preceding page,
Passenger's OWS indica- Passenger's lamp will be off and remain off.
be aware that the passenger's side front air-
bag will not deploy in the event of a collision. seat occu- tor light sta- side front If a person of adult size is sitting in the front
In this case, the SRS system and Occupant pancy status tus airbag sta- passenger's seat, but the PASSENGER
Weight Sensor should be inspected by a tus AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp is on, it is possible
trained and qualified Volvo service techni-
that the person isn't sitting properly in the seat.
cian as soon as possible. Seat unoc- OWS indica- Passenger's
If this happens:
cupied tor light side front
airbag disa- 1. Turn the vehicle off and ask the person to
WARNING bled place the seatback in an upright position.
lights up
Never try to open, remove, or repair any 2. Have the person sit upright in the seat,
components in the OWS system. This Seat occu- OWS indica- Passenger's centered on the seat cushion, with the per-
could result in system malfunction. pied by low tor light side front son's legs comfortably extended.
Maintenance or repairs should only be weight airbag disa-
carried out by an a trained and qualified 3. Restart the vehicle and have the person
occupant/ bled
Volvo service technician. lights up remain in this position for about two
objectA
The front passenger's seat should not minutes. This will allow the system to
be modified in any way. This could Seat occu- OWS indica- Passenger's detect that person and enable the pas-
reduce pressure on the seat cushion, pied by tor light side front senger's frontal airbag.
which might interfere with the OWS sys- heavy occu- airbag ena- 4. If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
tem's function. is
pant/object bled lamp remains on even after this, the person
not lit
should be advised to ride in the rear seat.
The OWS is designed to disable (will not inflate) A Volvo recommends that children always be properly
restrained in appropriate child restraints in the rear seats. Do This condition reflects limitations of the OWS
the passenger's side front airbag when a rear not assume that the passenger's side front airbag is disabled
unless the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp is lit.
classification capability. It does not indicate
facing infant seat, a forward-facing child
Make sure the child restraint is properly installed. If there is OWS malfunction.
restraint, or a booster seat is detected. The any doubt as to the status of the passenger's side front air-
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp will bag, move the child restraint to the rear seat.
Modifications
illuminate and stay on to remind you that the If you are considering modifying your vehicle in
The OWS is designed to enable (may inflate)
the passenger's side front airbag anytime the any way to accommodate a disability, for

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

27
01 Safety

01 Occupant Weight Sensor (OWS)

example by altering or adapting the driver's or WARNING WARNING


front passenger's seat(s) and/or airbag sys-
tems, please contact Volvo at: No objects that add to the total weight Keep the following points in mind with
on the seat should be placed on the respect to the OWS system. Failure to follow
In the USA front passenger's seat. If a child is these instructions could adversely affect the
seated in the front passenger's seat system's function and result in serious injury
Volvo Cars of North America, LLC to the occupant of the front passenger's
with any additional weight, this extra
Customer Care Center weight could cause the OWS system to seat:
P.O. Box 914 Rockleigh, New Jersey enable the airbag, which might cause it The full weight of the front seat passen-
07647-0914 to deploy in the event of a collision, ger should always be on the seat cush-
thereby injuring the child. ion. The passenger should never lift
1-800-458-1552 him/herself off the seat cushion using
The seat belt should never be wrapped
In Canada around an object on the front passeng- the armrest in the door or the center
er's seat. This could interfere with the console, by pressing the feet on the
Volvo Cars of Canada Corp. floor, by sitting on the edge of the seat
OWS system's function.
National Customer Service cushion, or by pressing against the
The front passenger's seat belt should backrest in a way that reduces pressure
175 Gordon Baker Road North York, Ontario never be used in a way that exerts more on the seat cushion. This could cause
M2H 2N7 pressure on the passenger than normal. OWS to disable the passenger's side
This could increase the pressure exer- front airbag.
1-800-663-8255 ted on the weight sensor by a child, and
could result in the airbag being enabled, Do not place any type of object on the
which might cause it to deploy in the front passenger's seat in such a way
event of a collision, thereby injuring the that jamming, pressing, or squeezing
child. occurs between the object and the front
seat, other than as a direct result of the
correct use of the Automatic Locking
Retractor/Emergency Locking Retrac-
tor (ALR/ELR) seat belt, see page 36.
No objects should be placed under the
front passenger's seat. This could inter-
fere with the OWS system's function.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

28
01 Safety

Side impact protection airbags 01

Side impact airbags front seats only WARNING


The SIPS airbag system is a supple-
ment to the structural Side Impact Pro-
tection System and the three-point seat
belt system. It is not designed to deploy
during collisions from the front or rear of
the car or in rollover situations.
The use of seat covers on the front seats
may impede SIPS airbag deployment.
No objects, accessory equipment or
stickers may be placed on, attached to

G025315
or installed near the SIPS airbag system
or in the area affected by SIPS airbag
G020118

deployment.
SIPS airbag deployment
Location of the side impact (SIPS) airbag
Never try to open or repair any compo-
nents of the SIPS airbag system. This
NOTE
As an enhancement to the structural side should be done only by a trained and
impact protection built into your car, the car is SIPS airbag deployment (one airbag) occurs qualified Volvo service technician.
also equipped with Side Impact Protection only on the side of the vehicle affected by
the impact. The airbags are not designed to In order for the SIPS airbag to provide
System (SIPS) airbags. its best protection, both front seat
deploy in all side impact situations.
The SIPS airbag system is designed to help occupants should sit in an upright posi-
increase occupant protection in the event of tion with the seat belt properly fastened.
Components in the SIPS airbag system
certain side impact collisions. The SIPS air- Failure to follow these instructions can
This SIPS airbag system consists of gas gen- result in injury to the occupants of the
bags are designed to deploy only during cer-
erators and side airbag modules built into the vehicle in the event of an accident.
tain side-impact collisions, depending on the
outboard sides of both front seat backrests.
crash severity, angle, speed and point of
impact.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

29
01 Safety

01 Volvo Inflatable Curtain (VIC)

The Volvo Inflatable Curtain system

G015265
This system consists of inflatable curtains NOTE WARNING
located along the sides of the roof liners,
stretching from the center of both front side If the inflatable curtain deploys, it remains The VIC system is a supplement to the
windows to the rear edge of the rear side door inflated for approximately 3 seconds. Side Impact Protection System. It is not
windows. It is designed to help protect the designed to deploy during collisions
heads of the occupants of the front seats and from the front or rear of the car or in roll-
over situations.
the occupant of the outboard rear seating posi-
tions in certain side impact collisions. Never try to open or repair any compo-
nents of the VIC system. This should be
In certain side impacts, both the Inflatable Cur- done only by a trained and qualified
tain (VIC) and the Side Impact Airbag System Volvo service technician.
(SIPS airbag) will deploy. The VIC and the SIPS
airbag deploy simultaneously. Never hang heavy items from the ceiling
handles. This could impede deployment
of the Inflatable curtain.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

30
01 Safety

Volvo Inflatable Curtain (VIC) 01

WARNING
In order for the VIC to provide its best pro-
tection, both front seat occupants and both
outboard rear seat occupants should sit in
an upright position with the seat belt prop-
erly fastened; adults using the seat belt and
children using the proper child restraint sys-
tem. Only adults should sit in the front seats.
Children must never be allowed in the front
passenger's seat, see page 36 for guide-
lines. Failure to follow these instructions can
result in injury to the vehicle occupants in an
accident.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

31
01 Safety

01 Whiplash Protection System

Whiplash Protection System (WHIPS) front seats only

G020347
The WHIPS system consists of specially WARNING WARNING
designed hinges and brackets on the front seat
backrests designed to help absorb some of the The WHIPS system is designed to sup- Occupants in the front seats must never
energy generated in a collision from the rear plement the other safety systems in sit out of position. The occupant's back
(when the vehicle is "rearended"). your car. For this system to function must be as upright as comfort allows
properly, the three-point seat belt must and be against the seat back with the
In the event of a collision of this type, the hinges be worn. Please be aware that no sys- seat belt properly fastened.
and brackets of the front seat backrests are tem can prevent all possible injuries that
designed to change position slightly to allow
If your car has been involved in a rear-
may occur in an accident. end collision, the front seat backrests
the backrest/head restraint to help support the The WHIPS system is designed to func- must be inspected by a trained and
occupant's head before moving slightly rear- tion in certain collisions from the rear, qualified Volvo service technician, even
ward. This movement helps absorb some of depending on the crash severity, angle if the seats appear to be undamaged.
the forces that could result in whiplash. and speed.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

32
01 Safety

Whiplash Protection System 01

Certain components in the WHIPS sys-


tem may need to be replaced.
Do not attempt to service any compo-
nent in the WHIPS system yourself.

G020125
WARNING

G020126

Boxes, suitcases, etc. wedged behind


the front seats could impede the func-
tion of the WHIPS system.
If the rear seat backrests are folded
WARNING down, cargo must be secured to pre-
Any contact between the front seat backr- vent it from sliding forward against the
ests and the folded rear seat could impede front seat backrests in the event of a
the function of the WHIPS system. If the rear collision from the rear. This could inter-
seat is folded down, the occupied front fere with the action of the WHIPS sys-
seats must be adjusted forward so that they tem.
do not touch the folded rear seat.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

33
01 Safety

01 Crash mode

Driving after a collision fuel lines, sensors for one of the safety sys- 3. Try to start the vehicle.
tems, the brake system, etc.
Moving the vehicle
WARNING If the electrical system is able to reset system
status to normal (CRASH MODE SEE
Never attempt to repair the vehicle MANUAL will no longer be displayed), the
yourself or to reset the electrical system vehicle may be moved carefully from its pres-
after the vehicle has displayed CRASH ent position, if for example, it is blocking traffic.
MODE SEE MANUAL. This could It should, however, not be moved farther than
result in injury or improper system func- is absolutely necessary.
tion.
Restoring the vehicle to normal operat- WARNING
ing mode should only be done by a
G026363
trained and qualified Volvo service tech- Even if the vehicle appears to be drivable
nician. after CRASH MODE has been set, it should
not be driven or towed (pulled by another
After CRASH MODE SEE MANUAL vehicle). There may be concealed damage
If the vehicle has been involved in a collision, has been displayed, if you detect the that could make it difficult or impossible to
odor of fuel vapor, or see any signs of control. The vehicle should be transported
the text CRASH MODE SEE MANUAL may
fuel leakage, do not attempt to start the on a flatbed tow truck to a trained and quali-
appear in the information display. This indi- fied Volvo service technician for inspection/
vehicle. Leave the vehicle immediately.
cates that the vehicle's functionality has been repairs.
reduced.
Attempting to start the vehicle
This text can only be shown if the display is
If damage to the vehicle is minor and there is
undamaged and the vehicle's electrical system
no fuel leakage, you may attempt to start the
is intact.
vehicle. To do so:
CRASH MODE is a feature that is triggered if
1. Remove the ignition key or optional keyless
one or more of the safety systems (for example,
drive start control, see page 146.
front or side airbags, an inflatable curtain, or
one or more of the seat belt pretensioners) has 2. Reinsert the key or start control in the igni-
deployed. The collision may have damaged an tion switch. The vehicle will then attempt to
important function in the vehicle, such as the reset CRASH MODE to normal mode.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

34
01 Safety

Child safety 01

Children should be seated safely restrained to help reduce the chance of injuring When a child has outgrown the child safety
Volvo recommends the proper use of restraint or increasing the injury of a child. seat, you should use the rear seat with the
systems for all occupants including children. standard seat belt fastened. The best way to
All states and provinces have legislation gov-
Remember that, regardless of age and size, a help protect the child here is to place the child
erning how and where children should be car-
child should always be properly restrained in a on a cushion so that the seat belt is properly
ried in a car. Find out the regulations existing
car. located on the hips (see the illustration on page
in your state or province. Recent accident sta-
42). Legislation in your state or province may
Your car is also equipped with ISOFIX/LATCH tistics have shown that children are safer in rear
mandate the use of a child seat or cushion in
attachments, which make it more convenient seating positions than front seating positions
combination with the seat belt, depending on
to install child seats. when properly restrained. A child restraint sys-
the child's age and/or size. Please check local
tem can help protect a child in a vehicle. Here's
Some restraint systems for children are regulations.
what to look for when selecting a child restraint
designed to be secured in the vehicle by lap system: A specially designed and tested booster cush-
belts or the lap portion of a lap-shoulder belt. ion (not available in Canada) can be obtained
Such child restraint systems can help protect It should have a label certifying that it
from your Volvo retailer for children weighing
children in cars in the event of an accident only meets applicable Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standards (FMVSS 213) or in Can- 33 80 lb. (15 36 kg) and 38-54 inches
if they are used properly. However, children (97 137 cm) in height.
could be endangered in a crash if the child ada, CMVSS 213.
restraints are not properly secured in the vehi- Make sure the child restraint system is
approved for the child's height, weight and WARNING
cle. Failure to follow the installation instructions
for your child restraint can result in your child development the label required by the Do not use child safety seats or child
striking the vehicle's interior in a sudden stop. standard or regulation, or instructions for booster cushions/backrests in the front
infant restraints, typically provide this infor- passenger's seat. We also recommend that
Holding a child in your arms is NOT a suitable mation. children under 4 feet 7 inches (140 cm) in
substitute for a child restraint system. In an height who have outgrown these devices sit
accident, a child held in a person's arms can
In using any child restraint system, we urge in the rear seat with the seat belt fastened.
you to carefully look over the instructions
be crushed between the vehicle's interior and that are provided with the restraint. Be sure
an unrestrained person. The child could also be you understand them and can use the
injured by striking the interior, or by being ejec- device properly and safely in this vehicle.
ted from the vehicle during a sudden maneuver A misused child restraint system can result
or impact. The same can also happen if the in increased injuries for both the infant or
infant or child rides unrestrained on the seat. child and other occupants in the vehicle.
Other occupants should also be properly

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

35
01 Safety

01 Child safety

Automatic Locking Retractor/ WARNING Volvo recommends that you do not dis-
Emergency Locking Retractor (ALR/ connect the airbag system in your vehicle.
Do not use child safety seats or child
ELR) booster cushions/backrests in the front Volvo strongly recommends that everyone
To make child seat installation easier, each passenger's seat. We also recommend that in the vehicle be properly restrained.
seat belt (except for the driver's belt) is equip- children who have outgrown these devices Volvo recommends that ALL occupants
ped with a locking mechanism to help keep the sit in the rear seat with the seat belt properly (adults and children) shorter than 4 feet
seat belt taut. fastened. 7 inches (140 cm) be seated in the back
seat of any vehicle with a front passenger
When attaching the seat belt to a child side airbag.
Volvo's recommendations
seat: Why does Volvo believe that no child should sit Drive safely!
1. Attach the seat belt to the child seat in the front seat of a car? It's quite simple really.
according to the child seat manufacturer's A front airbag is a very powerful device
instructions. designed, by law, to help protect an adult.
2. Pull the seat belt out as far as possible. Because of the size of the airbag and its speed
3. Insert the seat belt latch plate into the of inflation, a child should never be placed in
buckle (lock) in the usual way. the front seat, even if he or she is properly bel-
ted or strapped into a child safety seat. Volvo
4. Release the seat belt and pull it taut around
has been an innovator in safety for over sev-
the child seat.
enty-five years, and we'll continue to do our
A sound from the seat belt retractor will be part. But we need your help. Please remember
audible at this time and is normal. The belt will to put your children in the back seat, and
now be locked in place. This function is auto- buckle them up.
matically disabled when the seat belt is
unlocked and the belt is fully retracted. Volvo has some very specific
recommendations:
Always wear your seat belt.
Airbags are a SUPPLEMENTAL safety
device which, when used with a three-
point seat belt can help reduce serious
injuries during certain types of accidents.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

36
01 Safety

Child restraint systems 01

Child restraints WARNING


Always refer to the child restraint manufac-
turer's instructions for detailed information
on securing the restraint.

WARNING
When not in use, keep the child restraint
system secured or remove it from the
passenger compartment to help pre-
vent it from injuring passengers in the
event of a sudden stop or collision.

G026503
A small child's head represents a con-
G026491

siderable part of its total weight and its


Convertible seat neck is still very weak. Volvo recom-
Infant seat mends that children up to age 4 travel,
WARNING properly restrained, facing rearward. In
There are three main types of child restraint addition, Volvo recommends that chil-
systems: infant seats, convertible seats, and A child seat should never be used in the
dren should ride rearward facing, prop-
booster cushions. They are classified accord- front passenger seat of any vehicle with a
front passenger airbag not even if the erly restrained, as long as possible.
ing to the child's age and size.
Passenger airbag off symbol near the
The following section provides general infor- rear-view mirror is illuminated (on vehicles
mation on securing a child restraint using a equipped with Occupant Weight Sensor). If
three-point seat belt. Refer to pages 43 the severity of an accident were to cause the
45 for information on securing a child restraint airbag to inflate, this could lead to serious
injury or death to a child seated in this posi-
using ISOFIX lower anchors and/or top tether
tion.
anchorages.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

37
01 Safety

01 Infant seats

Securing an infant seat with a seat belt 1. Place the infant seat in the rear seat of the
vehicle.

G026492
G026417

G026493
Fasten the seat belt
Do not place the infant seat in the front passeng-
er's seat Positioning the seat belt through the infant seat WARNING
2. Attach the seat belt to the infant seat A child seat should never be used in the
NOTE front passenger seat of any vehicle with a
according to the manufacturer's instruc-
Refer to pages 4345 for information on front passenger airbag not even if the
tions. Passenger airbag off symbol near the
securing a child restraint using ISOFIX lower
anchors and/or top tether anchorages. rear-view mirror is illuminated (on vehicles
equipped with Occupant Weight Sensor). If
the severity of an accident were to cause the
WARNING airbag to inflate, this could lead to serious
injury or death to a child seated in this posi-
An infant seat must be in the rear-facing tion.
position only.
The infant seat should not be positioned 3. Fasten the seat belt by inserting the latch
behind the driver's seat unless there is plate into the buckle (lock) until a distinct
adequate space for safe installation. click is audible.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

38
01 Safety

Infant seats 01

and is normal. The seat belt should now be


locked in place.

G026494

G026498
Pull out the shoulder section of the seat belt
4. Pull the shoulder section of the seat belt
out as far as possible to activate the belt's Ensure that the seat is securely in place
automatic locking function.
WARNING
NOTE It should not be possible to move the child
The locking retractor will automatically restraint more than 1 in. (2.5 cm) in any
release when the seat belt is unbuckled and direction.
allowed to retract fully.
6. Push and pull the infant seat to ensure that
5. Press the infant seat firmly in place, let the it is held securely in place by the seat belt.
seat belt retract and pull it taut. A sound
7. The infant seat can be removed by unbuck-
from the seat belt retractor's automatic
ling the seat belt and letting it retract com-
locking function will be audible at this time
pletely.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

39
01 Safety

01 Convertible seats

Securing a convertible seat with a seat WARNING WARNING


belt
Always use a convertible seat that is suita- A small child's head represents a consider-
ble for the child's age and size. See the able part of its total weight and its neck is
convertible seat manufacturer's recommen- still very weak. Volvo recommends that chil-
dations. dren up to age 4 travel, properly restrained,
facing rearward. In addition, Volvo recom-
mends that children should ride rearward
facing, properly restrained, as long as pos-
sible.

WARNING
Convertible child seats should be instal-
led in the rear seat only.
G026420

A rear-facing convertible seat should not


be positioned behind the driver's seat
unless there is adequate space for safe
Do not place the convertible seat in the front pas- installation.
senger's seat

G026503
NOTE 1. Place the convertible seat in the rear seat
of the vehicle.
Refer to pages 4345 for information on Route the seat belt through the convertible seat
securing a child restraint using ISOFIX lower
anchors and/or top tether anchorages.

Convertible seats can be used in either a for-


ward or rearward-facing position, depending
on the age and size of the child.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

40
01 Safety

Convertible seats 01

NOTE WARNING
The locking retractor will automatically It should not be possible to move the child
release when the seat belt is unbuckled and restraint more than 1 in. (2.5 cm) in any
allowed to retract fully. direction.

5. Press the convertible seat firmly in place, The convertible seat can be removed by
let the seat belt retract and pull it taut. A unbuckling the seat belt and letting it retract
sound from the seat belt retractor's auto- completely.
matic locking function will be audible at this
time and is normal. The seat belt should
now be locked in place.
G026500

Fasten the seat belt


2. Attach the seat belt to the convertible seat
according to the manufacturer's instruc-
tions.
3. Fasten the seat belt by inserting the latch
plate into the buckle (lock) until a distinct

G026502
click is audible.
4. Pull the shoulder section of the seat belt
out as far as possible to activate the belt's Ensure that the seat is securely in place

G026501
automatic locking function.

Pull out the shoulder section of the seat belt


6. Push and pull the convertible seat to
ensure that it is held securely in place by
the seat belt.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

41
01 Safety

01 Booster cushions

Securing a booster cushion Booster cushions are recommended for chil-


dren who have outgrown convertible seats.
1. Place the booster cushion in the rear seat
of the vehicle.
2. With the child properly seated on the
booster cushion, attach the seat belt to or
around the cushion according to the man-
ufacturer's instructions.
3. Fasten the seat belt by inserting the latch
plate into the buckle (lock) until a distinct
click is audible.
4. Ensure that the seat belt is pulled taut and
G026489

fits snugly around the child.

Position the child correctly on the booster cushion WARNING


and fasten the seat belt
The hip section of the three-point seat
WARNING belt must fit snugly across the child's
hips, not across the stomach.
A child seat should never be used in the
front passenger seat of any vehicle with a The shoulder section of the three-point
front passenger airbag not even if the seat belt should be positioned across
Passenger airbag off symbol near the the chest and shoulder.
rear-view mirror is illuminated (on vehicles The shoulder belt must never be placed
equipped with Occupant Weight Sensor). If behind the child's back or under the
the severity of an accident were to cause the arm.
airbag to inflate, this could lead to serious
injury or death to a child seated in this posi-
tion.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

42
01 Safety

ISOFIX lower anchors 01

Using the ISOFIX lower child seat 3. Fasten the attachment on the child WARNING
anchors restraint's lower straps to the ISOFIX lower
anchors. The ISOFIX lower child restraint
anchors are only intended for use with
4. Firmly tension the lower child seat straps child seats positioned in the outboard
according to the manufacturer's instruc- seating positions. These anchors are
tions. not certified for use with any child
restraint that is positioned in the center
NOTE seating position. When securing a child
restraint in the center seating position,
The rear seat's center position is not use only the vehicle's center seat belt.
equipped with ISOFIX lower anchors.
When installing a child restraint in this
position, attach the restraint's top tether
strap (if it is so equipped) to the top
tether anchorage point (see page 45)
G015268

and secure the restraint with the vehi-


cle's center seat belt (see page 37).
ISOFIX lower child restraint anchors
Always follow your child seat manufac-
Lower anchors for ISOFIX-equipped child turer's installation instructions, and use
seats are located in the rear, outboard seats, both ISOFIX lower anchors and top
hidden below the backrest cushions. Symbols tethers whenever possible.
on the seat back upholstery mark the anchor
positions (see the illustration).

G031682
To access the anchors:
1. Put the child restraint in position.
2. Kneel on the child restraint to press down Fasten the attachment correctly to the ISOFIX
the seat cushion and locate the anchors by lower anchors
feel.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

43
01 Safety

01 ISOFIX lower anchors

WARNING
Be sure to fasten the attachment correctly
to the anchor (see the illustration). If the
attachment is not correctly fastened, the
child restraint may not be properly secured
in the event of a collision.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

44
01 Safety

Top tether anchors 01

Top tether anchors See page 43 for information on securing the


child restraint to ISOFIX lower anchors.

WARNING
Never route a top tether strap over the
top or around the head restraint. It
should always be routed under the head
restraint.
Child restraint anchorages are designed
to withstand only those loads imposed
by correctly fitted child restraints. Under

G026487
no circumstances are they to be used
for adult seat belts or harnesses. The
G029703

anchorages are not able to withstand


Route the strap under the head restraint excessive forces on them in the event of
Top tether anchorage points collision if full harness seat belts or adult
WARNING seat belts are installed to them. An adult
Volvo vehicles are equipped with child restraint who uses a belt anchored in a child
top tether anchorages in the rear seating posi- Be sure to fasten the child tether attachment restraint anchorage runs a great risk of
tions. They are located on the rear sides of the correctly to the anchor. If it is not correctly
suffering severe injuries should a colli-
backrests. fastened, the child seat may not be properly
restrained in the event of a collision. sion occur.
Using the top tether anchorages Do not install rear speakers that require
1. Place the child restraint on the rear seat. the removal of the top tether anchors or
3. Route the top tether strap under the head
interfere with the proper use of the top
2. Release the backrest and tilt it forward to restraint and fasten its attachment to the
tether strap.
access the anchorage. Attach the hook to anchorage.
the anchorage. Return the seat back to the 4. Firmly tension the top tether strap accord-
upright position and make sure it locks in ing to the child restraint manufacturer's
place. instructions. Tension the top tether strap
only after the lower anchor straps or the
seat belt have been firmly tensioned.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

45
01 Safety

01 Child restraint registration and recalls

Registering a child restraint


Child restraints could be recalled for safety
reasons. You must register your child restraint
to be reached in a recall. To stay informed
about child safety seat recalls, be sure to fill out
and return the registration card that comes
with new child restraints.
Child restraint recall information is readily avail-
able in both the U.S. and Canada. For recall
information in the U.S., call the U.S. Govern-
ment's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
In Canada, visit Transport Canada's Child
Safety website at http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety/childsafety/menu.htm.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

46
01 Safety

01

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

47
Instrument overview................................................................................ 50
Instrument panel..................................................................................... 53
Indicator and warning symbols............................................................... 55
Symbols instrument panel.................................................................... 57
Information display.................................................................................. 60
12-volt sockets........................................................................................ 62
Lighting panel.......................................................................................... 63
Left-side steering wheel lever................................................................. 66
Trip computer.......................................................................................... 68
Cruise control (option)............................................................................. 70
Right-side steering wheel lever............................................................... 72
Steering wheel adjustment, Hazard warning flashers............................. 74
Parking brake.......................................................................................... 75
Power windows....................................................................................... 76
Mirrors..................................................................................................... 78
Power moonroof (option)........................................................................ 81
Personal settings..................................................................................... 83

G020901
HomeLink Wireless Control System (option)....................................... 86

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

48
INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS

02
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
02 Instruments and controls

Instrument overview

02

G019488
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

50
02 Instruments and controls

Instrument overview

Steering wheel adjustment Not in use Parking brake


02
Hood opener Not is use 12-volt socket

Controls in front doors (see Courtesy lighting switch Position for optional equipment
page 52)
Driver's side reading light Position for optional equipment
Left steering wheel lever
Passenger's side reading light
Lighting panel, fuel filler door
opener Seat belt reminder and Occupant
Weight Sensor indicator
Door open handle and locking but-
ton Rear-view mirror
Climate system air vent Display for climate control, personal
settings, and audio system
Side window air vent
Audio system
Cruise control
Controls for personal settings and
Horn, airbag audio system

Main instrument panel Controls for climate system

Audio controls (option) Gear selector

Right steering wheel lever Hazard warning flashers

Ignition switch Door open handle, and locking but-


ton
Moonroof control (option)
Glove compartment

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

51
02 Instruments and controls

Instrument overview

Control panel in driver's door


02

G017435

Lockout switch for rear windows

Power windows

Door mirror button, driver's side

Door mirror adjustment control

Door mirror button, passenger's


side

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

52
02 Instruments and controls

Instrument panel

Instrument panel

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 02

G031465
8 9 10 11 12 13 14

Speedometer the temperature readings may be slightly sively high engines speeds. This will be
higher than the actual ambient tempera- noticeable as a pronounced unevenness in
Turn signal, left ture. engine speed.
Warning symbol See the following pages Information symbol See the following Indicator and warning symbols
for additional information. pages for additional information.
Fuel gauge, see page 267 for fuel tank vol-
Information display The display presents Turn signal, right ume. When a warning light in the gauge
information and warning messages, the comes on, the vehicle should be refueled
ambient temperature, clock, etc. When the Tachometer Shows engine speed in
thousands of revolutions per minute (rpm). as soon as possible. see page 68 for
ambient temperature is between 23 F and more information on fuel level and con-
36 F (5 C and +2 C), a snowflake sym- Do not drive continuously with the needle
in the red area of the dial, which indicates sumption in the "Trip computer section.
bol is shown in the display. This symbol
serves as a warning for possible slippery maximum allowable engine rpm range. High beam indicator
road surfaces. Please note that this symbol Instead, shift to a higher gear or slow the
vehicle down. The engine management Function display This window displays
does not indicate a fault with your car. At information on functions such as the
low speeds, or when the car is not moving, system will automatically prevent exces-

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

53
02 Instruments and controls

Instrument panel

odometer, trip odometers, optional rain


sensor, and cruise control.
02
Trip odometer reset button The trip
odometers are used to measure short dis-
tances. Press the button briefly to switch
between the odometer for the car's total
mileage and the two trip odometers, T1
and T2. A long press (more than 2 seconds)
resets the currently selected trip odometer.
Temperature gauge The gauge indicates
the temperature of the engine cooling sys-
tem. If the temperature is abnormally high
and the needle enters the red zone, a mes-
sage is shown in the display. Bear in mind
that auxiliary lamps in front of the air intake
reduce the cooling capacity at high outside
temperatures and high engine loads.
Indicator and warning symbols

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

54
02 Instruments and controls

Indicator and warning symbols

Function check Symbols in the center of the instrument If the red warning symbol lights up:
The indicator and warning symbols1 light up panel 1. Stop the car as soon as possible in a suit- 02
when you turn the ignition key or the optional able location.
keyless drive start control to the driving posi-
2. Read the message in the information dis-
tion (position II) before starting. This shows that
play.
the symbols are functioning.
3. Follow the instructions provided, or con-
CHECK When the engine starts, all sym-
ENGINE tact a trained and qualified Volvo service
bols go out. If the engine is not
technician. Erase the message by pressing
started within 5 seconds, all of the
READ, see page 60.
symbols except the malfunction
indicator light (CHECK ENGINE) Information symbol
and the oil pressure warning light The yellow information symbol
will go out. Certain symbols may lights up to alert the driver to a
not have their functions illustrated, depending

G026365
message in the information dis-
on the car's equipment. play. This symbol illuminates when
The PARK BRAKE symbol will not go out until the vehicle is traveling at speeds
the parking brake has been released. below 5 mph (7 km/h).
Warning symbol
The red warning symbol lights up The message can be erased by pressing the
to indicate a fault that could affect READ button, see page 60, or will disappear
the car's drivability.This symbol automatically (the length of time required for
illuminates when the vehicle is the message to disappear varies, depending
traveling at speeds above 5 mph on the function indicated).
(7 km/h). A text explaining the nature of the fault When the message "TIME FOR REGULAR
will also be shown in the information display.
SERVICE" is displayed, the text can be erased
The symbol and accompanying text will remain
and the information symbol light can be turned
on until the fault has been corrected. This sym-
off by pressing the READ button. The text will
bol may also light up in combination with other
disappear and the symbol light will go out auto-
indicator or warning symbols.
matically after two minutes.

1 On certain engines, the symbol for low oilpressure is not used. Instead, a text warningis provided in the information display, see page 216.
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

55
02 Instruments and controls

Indicator and warning symbols

This symbol may also light up in combination


with other indicator or warning symbols.
02
NOTE
The car can still be driven after the informa-
tion symbol has come on. The car can be
driven for 12 weeks after service-related
information has been displayed.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

56
02 Instruments and controls

Symbols instrument panel

Symbols left side in your car's behavior. Even so, an uncorrected 4. Stability system STC or DSTC
condition could hurt fuel economy, emission This indicator symbol flashes when
controls, and drivability. Extended driving with- the STC (Stability and Traction 02
out correcting the cause could even damage control system) or the DSTC
other components in your car. (Dynamic Stability and Traction
control system) is actively working
NOTE to stabilize the car, see page 155 for more
detailed information.
Canadian models are equipped with the
second symbol. 5. Tire Pressure Monitoring System
This system monitors inflation
2. Anti-lock Brake system (ABS) pressure in the tires. See page
G026439 If the warning light comes on, there 197 for more information.
is a malfunction of the ABS system
(the standard braking system will
still function). 6. Fuel level warning light
The vehicle should be driven to a trained and When this light comes on, the vehi-
1. Malfunction indicator light
qualified Volvo service technician for inspec- cle should be refueled as soon as
CHECK As you drive, a computer called
ENGINE tion, see page 153 for additional information. possible.
On-Board Diagnostics II (OBDII)
monitors your car's engine, trans-
mission, electrical and emission NOTE
systems. Canadian models are equipped with the
The CHECK ENGINE light will light second symbol.
up if the computer senses a condition that
potentially may need correcting. When this 3. Rear fog light
happens, please have your car checked by a This symbol indicates that the rear
trained and qualified Volvo service technician fog light (located in the driver's
as soon as possible. side taillight cluster) is on.
A CHECK ENGINE light may have many cau-
ses. Sometimes, you may not notice a change

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

57
02 Instruments and controls

Symbols instrument panel

Symbols right side 2. Parking brake applied 4. Oil pressure warning light1
This light is on when the parking If the light comes on while driving,
02 brake (hand brake) is applied. The the car, stop the engine immedi-
parking brake lever is situated ately, and check the engine oil
between the front seats, see level. If the oil level is normal and
page 75 for more information. the light stays on after restart, have
the car towed to the nearest trained and quali-
fied Volvo service technician. After hard driv-
ing, the light may come on occasionally when
the engine is idling. This is normal, provided it
goes off when the engine speed is increased.
NOTE
5. Seat belt reminder
G026438
Canadian models are equipped with the
second symbol. This symbol (and the seat belt
reminder light above the rear view
mirror) will light up if either front
3. SRS system warning light seat occupant has not buckled his/
1. Turn signal indicator for trailer (certain If this light comes on while the car her seat belt. If the car is not mov-
markets only) is being driven, or remains on for ing, the symbols will go out after approximately
If you are towing a trailer, this light longer than approximately 10 sec- 6 seconds.
will flash simultaneously with the onds after the car has been
turn signals on the trailer. If the started, the SRS system's diag- 6. Generator warning light
light does not flash when signaling, nostic functions have detected a fault in a seat If the light comes on while the
one of the turn signals on the trailer belt lock or pretensioner, a front airbag, side engine is running, have the charg-
or on the car are not functioning properly. impact airbag, and/or an inflatable curtain. ing system checked by an author-
Have the system(s) inspected by a trained and ized Volvo workshop.
qualified Volvo service technician as soon as
possible.

1 On certain engines, this symbol is not used to indicate low oil pressure. Instead, a text warning is provided in the information display, see also page 216.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

58
02 Instruments and controls

Symbols instrument panel

7. Brake failure warning light In this case: At higher speeds


If this light comes on while driving 1. Stop the car in a suitable place and switch If the car is moving at a speed
or braking, stop the car as quickly above approximately 6 mph 02
off the engine.
as possible in a safe place, open (10 km/h), the Warning symbol in
the hood, and check the brake fluid 2. Restart the engine. the instrument panel will light up
level in the reservoir, see 3. If both warning lights go off, no further and a message will be shown in the
page 215 for the location of the reservoir. action is required and the car can be information display indicating which door(s),
driven. etc is not completely closed.

4. If both lights remain on after the engine has Hood and trunk
been restarted, switch off the engine again If the hood and/or trunk is not com-
and check the brake fluid level, see pletely closed, the Information
page 215 for the location of the reservoir. symbol in the instrument panel will
NOTE light up and a message will be dis-
Door open warning played, regardless of the vehicle's
Canadian models are equipped with the speed.
second symbol. The driver will be alerted if one of the doors, the
hood or the trunk are open or ajar.
WARNING At low speeds
If the fluid level is below the MIN mark in the If the car is moving at a speed of
reservoir or if a Brake failure Service less than approximately 3 mph
urgent message is displayed in the infor- (5 km/h), the Information symbol in
mation display: DO NOT DRIVE. Have the the instrument panel will light up
car towed to a trained and qualified Volvo and a message will be shown in the
service technician and have the brake sys- information display indicating which door(s),
tem inspected. etc is not completely closed.

If the BRAKES and ABS warning lights come


on at the same time, this could indicate a fault
in the brake system.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

59
02 Instruments and controls

Information display

Messages NOTE Message Meaning


02 If a message is displayed when e.g. you are SERVICE Take your car to a
using the trip computer, this message must
be read before you can access the trip com- REQUIREDA trained and qualified
puter. Volvo service techni-
cian for inspection as
soon as possible (but
Message Meaning preferably before the
next scheduled mainte-
STOP SAFELYA Stop the vehicle in a nance service).
safe place and switch
off the engine to help BOOK TIME Book time for service at
prevent the risk of seri- FOR SERVICE an authorized Volvo
ous damage. workshop.
G019617

HIGH ENGINE Stop the vehicle in a TIME FOR This message is affec-
TEMP STOP safe place and switch REGULAR ted by the number of
When an indicator or warning light in the instru- SAFELY off the engine to help MAINTE- miles/km driven, by the
ment panel comes on, a message is also prevent the risk of seri- NANCE number of months, or
shown in the information display. To read a ous damage. by the number of engine
message: hours since the service
SERVICE Take your car to a reminder was reset at
1. Press the READ button (1).
URGENTA trained and qualified the most recent regu-
2. Pressing READ repeatedly enables you to Volvo service techni- larly scheduled service.
scroll to any other messages that may be cian for inspection
stored. immediately. MAINTE- If the vehicle is not serv-
NANCE OVER- iced according to
SEE MANUALA Refer to your owner's DUE schedule, the warranty
manual. For additional may not apply to dam-
information, please aged parts, etc.
contact your Volvo
retailer.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

60
02 Instruments and controls

Information display

Message Meaning
TIME FOR This message is affec- 02
REGULAR ted by the number of
MAINTE- miles/km driven, by the
NANCE number of months, or
by the number of engine
hours since the service
reminder was reset at
the most recent regu-
larly scheduled service.

REMINDER Stop as soon as possi-


CHECK OIL ble and switch off the
LEVEL engine, check the oil
level and top up if nec-
essary, see page 216.
A This is part of the message. Additional information will also
be displayed.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

61
02 Instruments and controls

12-volt sockets

12-volt socket (front seat) NOTE NOTE


02 The cover should be kept on when the aux- The 12-volt socket in the rear seat cannot
iliary socket is not in use. function as a cigarette lighter.

Auxiliary equipment
The buttons to the left of the 12-volt socket can
be used for Volvo-installed optional or auxiliary
equipment.

12-volt socket (rear seat)


G026349

12-volt socket, auxiliary equipment


The 12-volt socket can be used to plug in cer-
tain accessories such as cellular telephones,
etc. The maximum current is 10 A. The key
must be in position I (or higher) for the auxiliary
socket to function.

Ashtrays/cigarette lighter
The auxiliary socket can also be used for a cig-

G029082
arette lighter1, and ashtrays, which can be pur-
chased from your Volvo retailer.

1 Accessory.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

62
02 Instruments and controls

Lighting panel

Parking lights Active Bi-Xenon Lights (ABL)option


The front and rear parking lights can be turned
02
on even when the ignition is switched off.
Turn switch (1) to the parking light position.
The license plate lights also illuminate when the
parking lights are switched on.

Headlights
1. Turn the ignition key to position II.
2. The low beam headlights (daytime running
G026415 lights) illuminate automatically, except

G026507
when the light switch (1) is in the parking
light position1.
Pos. Lighting Lighting panel, vehicles with Active Bi-Xenon
NOTE headlights
Daytime running lights off. High See page 66 for information on switching When the ABL function is activated, the head-
beam flash only. between high and low beams. light beams adjust laterally to help light up a
Parking lights curve according to movements of the steering
wheel.
Daytime running lights. High This function can be activated by turning the
beams and high beam flash can lighting switch to the ABL position (indicated
be used in this position. by the arrow in the illustration). The indicator
light in the ABL symbol will illuminate.
The function can be deactivated by turning the
lighting switch counterclockwise to one of the
other lighting positions.

1 On Canadian models, the daytime running lights will remain on with the light switch in this position.
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

63
02 Instruments and controls

Lighting panel

Brake lights NOTE


The brake lights come on automatically when
02 The rear fog light is considerably brighter
the brakes are applied. than the normal taillights and should be
used only when conditions such as fog, rain,
Fog lights snow, smoke or dust reduce visibility for
other vehicles to less than 500 ft.
Front fog lights (option) (150 meters).
The front fog lights can be used in combination
with either the headlights or the parking lights.
Instrument panel lighting
1. Turn the ignition key to position II. The instrument panel lighting illuminates when
2. Press button (3) to turn on the front fog the ignition is in position II and the light switch
G020789
lights. (1) is in either position or .
An indicator light in the button illuminates when
Headlight pattern with ABL deactivated (left) and the front fog lights are on. NOTE
activated (right)
Rear fog light To make it easier to read the odometer, trip
NOTE odometer, clock, and ambient temperature,
The single rear fog light is located in the driver's these gauges illuminate when the vehicle is
This function can only be activated in side taillight cluster. unlocked and when the key has been
twilight or dark conditions, and only The rear fog light will only function in combi- removed from the ignition switch. The light-
when the vehicle is in motion. nation with the high/low beam headlights or the ing will go out when the vehicle is locked.
If the indicator light flashes, this indi- optional front fog lights.
cates a fault in the ABL system. A text Move the thumb wheel (2) up to increase
1. Turn the ignition key to position II.
message will also be displayed. brightness or down to decrease brightness.
2. Press button (5) to turn on the rear fog light.
An indicator light in the button illuminates when
the rear fog light is on.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

64
02 Instruments and controls

Lighting panel

Unlocking the fuel filler door


With the ignition switched off, press button (4)
02
to unlock the fuel filler door. Please note that
the fuel filler door will remain unlocked until the
car begins to move forward.
An audible click will be heard when the fuel filler
door re-locks.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

65
02 Instruments and controls

Left-side steering wheel lever

Lever positions Turn signals High/low beam headlights


02 When turning Continuous high beams
Move the lever as far up or down as pos- 1. Turn the ignition key to position II.
sible (to position 2) to start the turn signals.
2. With the light switch (1) in position ,
The turn signals will be cancelled automatically see page 63, pull the turn signal lever
by the movement of the steering wheel, or the toward the steering wheel (position 4) to
lever can be returned to its initial position by toggle between high and low beams.
hand.
High beam flash
When changing lanes 1. Turn the ignition key to position II.
The driver can automatically flash the turn sig-
nals 3 times by: 2. Pull the turn signal lever to position 3. The
high beams will remain on until the lever is
G026954

Moving the turn signal lever up or down to released.


position 1 and releasing it.
Turn signals, lane change position Moving the lever up or down to position 2 Home safe lighting
and immediately back to its original posi- When you leave your car at night, you can
Turn signals, position for normal turns tion. make use of the home safe lighting function to
illuminate the area in front of the car.
High beam flash
NOTE 1. Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Toggle between high and low beams,
This automatic flashing sequence can 2. Pull the direction indicator lever as far as
Home Safe lighting be interrupted by immediately moving possible towards the steering wheel (to
the lever in the opposite direction. position 4) and release it.
If the turn signal indicator flashes faster
3. Exit the car and lock the doors.
than normal, check for a burned-out
turn signal bulb. The headlights and parking lights will illuminate
and remain on for 301, 60 or 90 seconds. The
time interval can be changed according to your

1 Factory setting

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

66
02 Instruments and controls

Left-side steering wheel lever

preferences by using the Personal Settings


function, see page 83 for more information.
02

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

67
02 Instruments and controls

Trip computer

ACTUAL SPEED (current speed in mph, MILES TO EMPTY TANK


Canadian models only) This function shows the approximate distance
02 that can be driven on the fuel remaining in the
STC/DSTC, see page 155
tank. The calculation is based on average fuel
NOTE consumption during the last 20 miles (30 km)
of driving and the amount of fuel remaining in
Warning messages from the car's monitor- the tank when the reading was taken.
ing systems will override the trip computer
function. When the message ---- miles to empty tank
appears in the display, refuel as soon as pos-
If a warning message is shown in the informa- sible.
tion display while you are using the trip com- AVERAGE
G029052 puter: This value indicates fuel consumption since the
last time the trip computer was reset, by press-
1. Acknowledge the message by pressing the
ing RESET (button 3). When the engine is
READ (press to acknowledge/confirm/ READ (button 1).
switched off, information on fuel consumption
erase a message) 2. Press READ again to return to the trip is stored and remains in system memory until
Thumb wheel (used to scroll among the trip computer function. RESET (button 3) is pressed again.
computer menus)
INSTANTANEOUS
RESET Controls This value indicates the current fuel consump-
The trip computer functions can be accessed tion, based on readings taken once per sec-
The trip computer stores information gathered
by twisting the thumb wheel (2) one step at a ond. When the car is not moving, "----" will be
from several systems in your car and has four
time in either direction. Twisting a final time displayed.
menus (five on Canadian models) that can be
returns you to the original function.
shown in the information display. AVERAGE SPEED
MILES TO EMPTY TANK Resetting This value indicates average speed since the
AVERAGE (average fuel consumption) and last time the trip computer was reset, by press-
AVERAGE (average fuel consumption) ing RESET (button 3). When the engine is
AVERAGE SPEED can be reset.
INSTANTANEOUS (current fuel con- switched off, information on average speed is
sumption) 1. Select one of these functions. stored and remains in system memory until the
AVERAGE SPEED 2. Press RESET (3). RESET (button 3) is pressed again.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

68
02 Instruments and controls

Trip computer

ACTUAL SPEED (Canadian models only)


This function provides the driver with an instan-
taneous conversion of the car's current speed 02
from km/h to mph.

NOTE
Trip computer readings may vary slightly
depending on the circumference of the tires
on the car, tire inflation, or driving style.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

69
02 Instruments and controls

Cruise control (option)

Engaging the cruise control function Increasing or decreasing speed NOTE


02 Cruise control will not function at
speeds below 20 mph (30 km/h).
Momentary acceleration, for less than
1 minute (e.g. when passing another
car), does not affect cruise control oper-
ation. The car will automatically return
to the previously set speed when the
accelerator pedal is released.

Temporarily disengaging the cruise


control
G020141

G031667
Press 0 to temporarily disengage cruise
control.
The cruise control buttons are located on the Use + or in the following ways to increase or CRUISE will appear in the function display.
left side of the steering wheel hub. decrease the vehicle's speed: The currently set speed is stored in the sys-
tem's memory.
1. Press and hold down + or until the vehicle
NOTE reaches the desired speed. This will
This does not set the vehicle's speed. become the set speed when the button is Cruise control is also automatically
released. disengaged:
1. Press the CRUISE button. CRUISE will 2. Press + or for approximately a half sec- If the speed drops below approximately
20 mph (30 km/h) when driving uphill.
appear in the function display in the center ond and release the button to increase or
of the instrument panel. decrease vehicle speed by approximately When the brake or clutch pedal is
1 mph (1.6 km/h). depressed.
2. Press + or to set the current speed.
CRUISE ON will be displayed. If the gear selector is moved to posi-
tion N.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

70
02 Instruments and controls

Cruise control (option)

During wheel spin or wheel lock-up.


If the vehicle's speed is increased by using
02
the accelerator pedal for more than 1
minute.

Returning to the set speed


Press the button to resume the
previously set speed. CRUISE
ON will be displayed.

Disengaging cruise control


Cruise control can also be disengaged by:
Pressing the CRUISE button (CRUISE
ON will no longer be shown in the function
display).
Putting the gear selector in Neutral (N).

WARNING
Cruise control should not be used in heavy
traffic or when driving on wet or slippery
roads. Cruise control may not maintain set
speed on steep downgrades.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

71
02 Instruments and controls

Right-side steering wheel lever

Windshield wipers Manual wiper function CAUTION


From position 0, move the lever
02 upward. The windshield wipers will Use ample washer fluid when washing
sweep one stroke at a time for as the windshield. The windshield should
be thoroughly wet when the wipers are
B C long as the lever is held up.
0
in operation.
Intermittent wiper function Before using the wipers, ice and snow
0
A should be removed from the wind-
With the lever in this position, you
shield/rear window. Be sure the wiper
can set the wiper interval by mov-
blades are not frozen in place.
ing the thumb wheel (C) upward to
increase wiper speed or down-
ward to decrease the speed.
Headlight washers (certain models)
When the lever has been pulled, high pressure
G025419

Continuous wiper function


The wipers operate at "normal" jets mounted in the bumper will spray the head-
speed. lights.
Windshield/headlight washers The following applies to conserve washer fluid,
High speed wiper function.
Rain sensor (option) on/of, see page 72 see page 63 for information on the light switch
positions:
Thumb wheel
AWindshield washers Low/high beam headlights on
Windshield wipers off Pull the lever toward the steering wheel and The headlights will be washed the first time the
The windshield wipers are off when release it. The wipers will make 23 sweeps windshield is washed. Thereafter, the head-
the lever is in position 0. across the windshield after the lever has been lights will only be washed once for every five
released. times the windshield is washed within a 10-
minute period.

Parking lights on
Optional Bi-Xenon headlights will be washed
once for every five times the windshield is
washed.
Normal halogen headlights will not be washed.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

72
02 Instruments and controls

Right-side steering wheel lever

B Rain sensor (option) 3. Press button B (see page 72). The rain sen- C Thumb wheel
sor symbol will appear in the lower display. The thumb wheel is used to set the wiper inter-
02
val when intermittent wiping is selected, or the
Manual deactivation
sensitivity to the amount of rain on the wind-
The rain sensor can be deactivated by:
shield when the rain sensor is selected. Move
Pressing button (B). the wheel upward or downward to increase/
or decrease wiper speed when the intermittent
function is selected, or to increase/decrease
Moving the windshield wiper lever down. the optional rain sensor's sensitivity when the
this function is activated.
NOTE
The rain sensor function will remain acti-
G026422
vated if the lever is briefly moved up to
activate the "manual sweep" function.

The rain sensor regulates windshield wiper CAUTION


speed according to the amount of water on the The rain sensor should be deactivated when
windshield. The sensitivity of the rain sensor is washing the car in an automatic car wash,
adjusted by moving the thumb wheel (C in the etc. If the rain sensor function is left on, the
illustration on the previous page) up (the wipers wipers will start inadvertently in the car
wash and could be damaged.
will sweep the windshield more frequently) or
down (the wipers will sweep the windshield
less frequently). Automatic deactivation
The rain sensor is deactivated automatically in
On/Off the following situations:
Activating the rain sensor When the key is removed from the ignition.
1. Switch on the ignition.
Five minutes after the ignition is switched
2. Put the windshield wiper lever in position off if the key is left in the ignition.
0.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

73
02 Instruments and controls

Steering wheel adjustment, Hazard warning flashers

Steering wheel adjustment Check that the steering wheel is locked in the NOTE
new position.
02 Regulations regarding the use of the
hazard warning flasher may vary,
WARNING
depending on where you live.
Never adjust the steering wheel while driv-
ing.
The hazard warning flashers will be acti-
vated automatically if an airbag
deploys.
Hazard warning flashers

G020143

Both the height and the reach of the steering


wheel can be adjusted to a comfortable posi-
tion for the driver.
1. Pull down the lever on the steering column
to release the steering wheel.

G020144
2. Adjust the steering wheel to a suitable
position
3. Press the lever back into place to lock the The four-way flasher should be used to indi-
steering wheel in the new position. If nec- cate that the vehicle has become a traffic haz-
essary, press the steering wheel slightly ard. To activate the flashers, press the triangu-
while pressing the lever into the locked lar button in the center dash. Press the button
position. again to turn off the flashers.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

74
02 Instruments and controls

Parking brake

Parking brake (hand brake) 4. If the vehicle rolls, the parking brake lever
must be pulled more firmly.
02
5. When parking a vehicle always put the gear
selector in first gear (for manual transmis-
sion) or P (for automatic transmission).

Parking on a hill
If the vehicle is pointing uphill, turn the front
wheels so that they point away from the
curb.
If the vehicle is pointing downhill, turn the
front wheels so that they point toward the
G026348
curb.

Releasing the parking brake


1. Press firmly on the brake pedal.
The parking brake lever is located between the 2. Pull the lever up slightly, press the button
front seats. at the end of the lever and lower the lever
completely.
NOTE
The indicator light will illuminate even if the WARNING
parking brake has only been partially Pull up the parking brake lever up firmly to
applied. its full extent.

When applying the parking brake


1. Press firmly on the brake pedal.
2. Pull the parking brake lever up firmly to its
full extent.
3. Release the brake pedal and ensure that
the vehicle is at a standstill.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

75
02 Instruments and controls

Power windows

Operation Opening a window to close a window to the position of your


Lightly press down the front edge of any of the choice.
02 buttons (A or B) to the first detent ("stop") to Pull the front part of any of the buttons (A
open a window to the position of your choice. or B) up as far as possible and release to
automatically close the window com-
WARNING pletely. To stop the window at any time,
press the button down.
Always remove the ignition key when
the vehicle is unattended.
Lockout switch for rear windows
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
Make sure that the windows are com-
G017439 pletely unobstructed before they are
operated.

Control panel in driver's door Press the front part of any of the buttons (A
or B) as far down as possible and release
Open/close front windows to automatically open the window com-
Open/close rear windows pletely.

The power windows are controlled by buttons


To stop the window at any time, pull the
button up.
in the arm rests.

G017440
The ignition must be ON (ignition key in NOTE
position I, II or the engine running) for the
power windows to function. To reduce buffeting wind noise if the rear Lockout switch
windows are opened, also open the front
The power windows will also function after The electrically operated rear door windows
windows slightly.
the ignition has been switched off as long can be disabled by a switch located on the
as neither of the front doors has been driver's door (see illustration).
opened. Closing a window
If the light in the switch is OFF: The rear door
Lightly pull up the front edge of any of the
buttons (A or B) to the first detent ("stop") windows can be raised or lowered with the

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

76
02 Instruments and controls

Power windows

buttons on the rear door armrests or with the Power window controls rear doors
buttons on the driver's door armrest.
02
If the light in the switch is ON: The rear door
windows can only be raised or lowered with the
buttons on the driver's door.

Power window control front


passenger's side

G028208
The rear door windows can be operated with
the control on each door and with the switch
on the driver's door.
G019511

The control for the power window in the front


passenger's door operates that window only.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

77
02 Instruments and controls

Mirrors

Rearview mirror Rearview mirror with compass (option) Calibrating the compass
02

G031045
G020146

G029930
Day/night control The upper right-hand corner of the rearview The earth is divided into 15 magnetic zones.
mirror has an integrated display that shows the The compass is initially set for the zone to
Normal position
compass direction toward which the car is which the car was delivered, and should
Night position, reduces glare from follow- pointing. Eight different directions can be dis- always be adjusted if the car is driven to a new
ing traffic played: N, NE, E, SE, S, SW, W and NW. The magnetic zone. A "C" will be displayed if cali-
display shows your car's orientation with bration becomes necessary.
Night position respect to true north. To calibrate the compass:
To reduce glare from the headlights of follow-
ing vehicles, use control (1) to switch between 1. Stop the car in a large, open area, away
the normal and night-driving positions. from traffic.

Auto-dim function (option) 2. Using a pen or similar object, hold the but-
An optional integrated sensor reacts to head- ton (1) depressed for at least 6 seconds.
lights from following traffic and automatically "C" will be displayed.
reduces glare.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

78
02 Instruments and controls

Mirrors

Power door mirrors Driver's door mirror:


Press the L button (a light in the switch will
go on) to activate the adjustment control. 02
Use this control to adjust the driver's door
mirror.

Passenger's door mirror:


1. Press the R switch (a light in the switch will
go on) to activate the adjustment control.
Use this control to adjust the passenger's
door mirror.
2. After you have adjusted the mirror(s), press
G026409
the L or R switch again (the LED will go out)

G018252
to deactivate the adjustment control.
Magnetic zones
Storing the mirrors' position
3. Press button (1) for at least 3 seconds to The mirror control switches are located on the
The position of the door mirrors is stored when
display the number of the current magnetic driver's door armrest.
the vehicle is locked. The next time the driver's
zone. The mirror control switches are located on the door is unlocked with the same remote control
4. Press button (1) repeatedly until the num- driver's door armrest. and that door is opened within 2 minutes, the
ber for the required geographical area optional power driver's seat and side door mir-
(1 15) is displayed. "C" will be displayed Adjusting the mirrors rors will automatically move to the position that
again. they were in when the doors were most
WARNING recently locked with the same remote control.
5. Drive slowly in a circle at a maximum speed
of 6 mph (10 km/h) until a compass direc- The mirrors should always be adjusted Folding power door mirrors (option on
tion is displayed. prior to driving. certain markets only)
Calibration is complete. Objects seen in the passenger's side The mirrors can be folded in for parking/driving
wide-angle door mirror are closer than in narrow spaces.
they appear to be.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

79
02 Instruments and controls

Mirrors

Folding the mirrors in Return to "neutral" position


1. Press down the L and R mirror control but- If a mirror has been inadvertently moved (bum-
02 tons on the driver's door at the same time. ped in a parking lot, etc.) from its original (neu-
tral) position, it must be moved back to this
2. Release them after approximately one sec-
position before automatic folding will function
ond. The mirrors automatically fold in to the
again.
fully retracted position.
Folding the mirrors out To so so:
Fold out the mirrors by pressing down the L 1. Fold in the mirrors by pressing the L and
and R buttons at the same time. The mirrors R mirror control buttons on the driver's
automatically fold out to the fully extended door at the same time.
position.
2. Fold them out again by pressing the L and
Automatic folding R mirror control buttons.
When the vehicle is locked/unlocked with the
This returns the mirrors to their original (neutral)
remote control or with the optional keyless
positions.
drive system (see page 123), the power door
mirrors with automatically fold in or out. Blind Spot Information System (BLIS) -
option
NOTE The Blind Spot Information System (BLIS) is an
The door mirrors will not fold out automati- information system that indicates the presence
cally when the vehicle is unlocked if they of another vehicle in the side-view mirror's
were folded in using the buttons on the driv- "blind area." See page 164 for detailed infor-
er's door control panel. mation.

This function can be activated/deactivated in


Personal settings (see page 83). In the menu
system, go to Car settings Fold mirr. when
locking.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

80
02 Instruments and controls

Power moonroof (option)

Operating the moonroof Sliding moonroof


Auto open/close 02
Open: Pull the switch as far back as possible
(to position 1) and release it to automatically
slide open the moonroof.
Close: Push the switch as far forward as pos-
sible (to position 4) and release it to automati-
cally close the moonroof.
Manual open/close
Open: Pull the switch back to the first stop
(position 2) and hold it until the moonroof has

G029222
G007503
opened to the position of your choice.
Close: Push the switch forward to the first stop
Moonroof control in the ceiling console (position 3) and hold it until the moonroof has
Auto open closed to the position of your choice, or has
To operate the moonroof, the ignition key must
closed completely.
first be turned to the intermediate or drive posi- Manual open
tion (position I, II or the engine running). The
moonroof can be opened in two ways: Manual close NOTE
Tilt position Auto close If the moonroof is repeatedly obstructed
during auto-close operation, an overload
Sliding moonroof Tilt open circuit breaker will temporarily halt moon-
roof function. The moonroof will return to
Tilt close normal function after a brief cool-down
period.
Tilt position
Open: Press the rear edge of the control
upward to position 5.
Close: Pull the rear edge of the control down to
position 6.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

81
02 Instruments and controls

Power moonroof (option)

CAUTION Visor
02 Remove ice and snow before opening
the moonroof.
Do not operate the moonroof if it is fro-
zen closed.
Never place heavy objects on the
moonroof.

WARNING
If the moonroof is obstructed during
auto-close operation, it will automati-

G020157
cally reverse direction and return to its
starting position.
During manual closing, if the moonroof
is obstructed, immediately open it The optional moonroof features a sliding visor.
again. The visor slides open automatically when the
moonroof is opened, and must be closed man-
ually.
WARNING
Never open or close the moonroof if it is
obstructed in any way.
Never allow a child to operate the
moonroof.
Never extend any object or body part
though the open moonroof, even if the
vehicle's ignition is completely
switched off.
Never leave a child alone in a vehicle.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

82
02 Instruments and controls

Personal settings

Control panel Personal settings can be made for some of the 2. Select hour(s) or minute(s) to be changed
car's functions, such as the central locking with the left/right arrow keys.
system, climate control, and the audio system. 02
3. Press ENTER to start the clock.
Please refer to page 241 for more information
on the audio functions that can be adjusted.
The settings are presented in the display (A). NOTE
A If you are currently using the 12-hour time
To access the menu and adjust settings setting, use the up/down arrow keys to
1. Press MENU (B). select AM/PM after the minute-setting has
been adjusted.
2. Scroll to Car Settings using the menu nav-
igation control (E).
Lock confirmation light
3. Press ENTER (D).
When the car is locked/unlocked with the
E B
4. Select an alternative using the menu navi- remote control, the direction indicators can be
D C gation control (E). selected to flash to confirm the action. The
alternatives On/Off are available for both lock-
5. Confirm your selection by pressing
ing and unlocking.
ENTER.
Autolock
To exit the menu
When the car starts to move, the doors and
Press EXIT (C).
G026307

trunk can be locked automatically. The alter-


natives On/Off are available.
Available settings
Display
Clock adjust
NOTE
Menu button Pulling the handle twice on a door unlocks
To set the time:
Exit button and opens that door.
1. Use the number keys or the up/down arrow
Enter button keys on the navigation control (E) to
change the hour or minute. Unlock
Menu navigation controls There are two alternatives for unlocking:

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

83
02 Instruments and controls

Personal settings

Global (All doors) unlocks all doors and Temporarily turning off the alarm Information
the trunk with one press on the remote sensor(s) VIN number The VIN (Vehicle Identifica-
02 control. tion Number) is the car's unique identity
The alarm sensors can be temporarily turned
Two Step (Two-stage unlocking) This off (if, for example, a person or a pet remains number.
alternative unlocks the driver's door with in the vehicle when the doors are locked from Number of Keys the number of keys reg-
one press on the remote control. A second outside with the remote control). There are two istered for the car is displayed here.
press unlocks the passenger's door and alternatives:Activate once and Ask on exit,
the trunk see page 118 and 130 . Climate functions
Blower speed in AUTO mode the blower
Automatically folding the door mirrors Approach lighting speed can be set to AUTO mode in models
The setting makes it possible to automatically This alternative determines the length of time equipped with ECC. Choose between
fold the door mirrors in or out when the vehicle for which the car's lights will remain on when "Low", "Normal" and "High".
is locked or unlocked. See page 79. the Approach light button on the central lock- Timer for recirculation when the timer is
ing system's remote control is pressed. Inter- active, the air recirculates in the car for 3
Operating side windows
vals of 30/60/90 seconds may be selected, see 12 minutes depending on the ambient tem-
The following alternative can be selected for
teh section "Remote control functions" for perature. Select On/Off depending on
opening all side windows at the same time by whether the recirculation timer is to be
more information.
pressing and holding the Unlock switch in active or not.
either of the front doors (see page 127 for Home safe lighting
additional information) 1 This alternative determines the length of time Keyless locking and unlocking (option as
for which the car's lights will remain on when available)
NOTE the high beam lever on the steering column is The following alternatives can be selected for
pulled toward the wheel with the ignition locking and unlocking the doors and trunk:
The ignition key must be in position I or
switched off. Intervals of 30/60/90 seconds
higher (see page 143) before all side win- All doors all doors are locked or unlocked
dows can be opened using the switches in may be selected, see page 66 for information at the same time.
the front doors. on using this function.
Doors on the same side front and rear
doors on the same side are unlocked
Auto open all windows On/Off together.

1 This menu alternative also makes it possible to open all side windows by pressing and holding the Unlock button on the remote control for several seconds.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

84
02 Instruments and controls

Personal settings

Both front doors both front doors are


unlocked together.
02
One front door either of the front doors
can be unlocked separately2.

Reset to factory settings


Use this alternative to return to the default cli-
mate system settings.

2 Factory default.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

85
02 Instruments and controls

HomeLink Wireless Control System (option)

Introduction WARNING Programming HomeLink


02 If you use HomeLink to open a garage
NOTE
door or gate, be sure no one is near the
gate or door while it is in motion. Some vehicles may require the ignition
switch to be turned on or to the second
When programming a garage door
(accessories) position for programming
opener, it is advised to park outside of and/or operation of HomeLink. It is also rec-
the garage. ommended that a new battery be placed in
Do not use HomeLink with any garage the hand-held transmitter of the device
door opener that lacks safety stop and being programmed to HomeLink for quicker
reverse features as required by U.S. training and accurate transmission of the
federal safety standards (this includes radio-frequency signal.
G030070 any garage door opener model manu-
factured before April 1, 1982). A garage 1. Position the end of your hand-held trans-
door that cannot detect an object - sig- mitter 13 inches (514 cm) away from the
naling the door to stop and reverse - HomeLink button you wish to program
does not meet current U.S. federal while keeping the indicator light in view.
The HomeLink Wireless Control System pro-
safety standards. For more information,
vides a convenient way to replace up to three 2. Simultaneously press and hold both the
contact HomeLink at:
hand-held radio-frequency (RF) transmitters chosen HomeLink and hand-held transmit-
www.homelink.com.
used to activate devices such as gate opera- ter buttons until the HomeLink indicator
tors, garage door openers, entry door locks, light changes from a slow to a rapidly blink-
security systems, even home lighting. Addi- Retain the original transmitter of the RF device
ing light. Now you may release both the
tional HomeLink information can be found on you are programming for use in other vehicles
HomeLink and hand-held transmitter but-
the Internet at www.homelink.com. as well as for future HomeLink programming. It
tons.
is also suggested that upon the sale of the
vehicle, the programmed HomeLink buttons be
erased for security purposes. Refer to Erasing
HomeLink Buttons.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

86
02 Instruments and controls

HomeLink Wireless Control System (option)

NOTE found where the hanging antenna wire is cedures, replace Programming HomeLink
attached to the motor-head unit. step 2 with the following:
Some devices may require you to replace 02
this Programming Step 2 with procedures 5. Firmly press and release the learn or Continue to press and hold the HomeLink
noted in the Gate Operator / Canadian Pro- smart button. (The name and color of the button while you press and release -
gramming section. If the HomeLink indica- button may vary by manufacturer.) There every two seconds (cycle) your hand-
tor light does not change to a rapidly are 30 seconds to initiate step 6. held transmitter until the HomeLink indica-
blinking light after performing these steps, tor light changes from a slow to a rapidly
contact HomeLink at www.homelink.com. 6. Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold blinking light. Now you may release both
for two seconds and release the pro- the HomeLink and hand-held transmitter
grammed HomeLink button. Repeat the buttons.
3. Firmly press, hold for five seconds and
press/hold/release sequence a second
release the programmed HomeLink but- Proceed with Programming step 3 to com-
time, and, depending on the brand of the
ton up to two separate times to activate the plete.
garage door opener (or other rolling code
door. If the door does not activate, press
equipped device), repeat this sequence a
and hold the just-trained HomeLink button
third time to complete the programming Using HomeLink
and observe the indicator light.
process. To operate, simply press and release the pro-
If the indicator light stays on con-
HomeLink should now activate your rolling grammed HomeLink button. Activation will
stantly, programming is complete now occur for the trained device (i.e., garage
and your device should activate when code equipped device.
door opener, gate operator, security system,
the HomeLink button is pressed and Gate Operator/Canadian Programming entry door lock, home/office lighting, etc.). For
released.
Canadian radio-frequency laws require trans- convenience, the hand-held transmitter of the
If the indicator light blinks rapidly for mitter signals to time-out (or quit) after sev- device may also be used at any time. In the
two seconds and then turns to a con- eral seconds of transmission which may not event that there are still programming difficul-
stant light continue with Program- be long enough for HomeLink to pick up the ties or questions, contact HomeLink at:
ming steps 4-6 to complete the pro- signal during programming. Similar to this www.homelink.com.
gramming of a rolling code equipped Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators are
device (most commonly a garage door designed to time-out in the same manner.
opener).
If you live in Canada or you are having difficul-
4. At the garage door opener receiver (motor-
ties programming a gate operator or garage
head unit) in the garage, locate the learn
door opener by using the Programming pro-
or smart button. This can usually be

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

87
02 Instruments and controls

HomeLink Wireless Control System (option)

Erasing HomeLink Buttons This device complies with FCC rules part 15
To erase programming from the three Home- and Industry Canada (IC) RSS-210. Operation
02 is subject to the following two conditions: (1)
Link buttons (individual buttons cannot be
erased but can be reprogrammed as outlined This device may not cause harmful interfer-
below), follow the step noted: ence, and (2) This device must accept any
interference that may be received including
Press and hold the two outer HomeLink interference that may cause undesired opera-
buttons until the indicator light begins to tion.
flash-after 10 seconds. Release both but-
tons. Do not hold for longer that 20 sec-
onds. HomeLink is now in the train (or NOTE
learning) mode and can be programmed at The transmitter has been tested and com-
any time beginning with Programming - plies with FCC and IC rules. Changes or
step 1. modifications not expressly approved by
the party responsible for compliance could
void the users authority to operate the
Reprogramming a Single HomeLink device.1
Button
To program a device to HomeLink using a HomeLink and the HomeLink house are regis-
HomeLink button previously trained, follow tered trademarks of Johnson Controls, Inc.
these steps:
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink but-
ton. DO NOT release the button.
2. The indicator light will begin to flash after
20 seconds. Without releasing the Home-
Link button, proceed with Programming
- step 1.
For questions or comments, contact HomeLink
at: www.homelink.com or 18003553515.

1 The term IC: before the certification/registration number only signifies that Industry Canada technical specifications were met.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

88
02 Instruments and controls

02

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

89
General information................................................................................. 92
Air vents.................................................................................................. 94
Manual climate control............................................................................ 95
Electronic Climate Control (ECC) option.............................................. 98

G020906
Air distribution....................................................................................... 101

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

90
CLIMATE

03
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
03 Climate

General information

Air conditioning A/C Fog on the inside of the windows Passenger compartment filter
Your car is equipped with a climate control The defroster function should be used to Replace the cabin air filter with a new one at
system that includes either manually adjusta- remove fog or mist from the inside of the win- the recommended intervals. Please refer to
ble air conditioning or optional Electronic Cli- dows. Keeping the windows clean with a com- your Warranty and Service Records Informa-
mate Control (ECC). mercially available window washing spray will tion booklet, or consult a trained and qualified
also help prevent fogging or misting Volvo service technician for these intervals.
The air conditioning system can be switched
03 The filter should be replaced more often when
off, but for optimal air quality in the passenger
driving under dirty and dusty conditions. The
compartment and to prevent the windows from Climate control maintenance
filter cannot be cleaned and therefore should
fogging, the air conditioning should be left on Special tools and equipment are required to always be replaced with a new one.
even in cool weather. maintain and carry out repairs on the climate
system. Work of this type should only be done
NOTE by a trained and qualified Volvo service tech-
NOTE
nician. There are different types of cabin air filters.
In warm weather, a small amount of water
Ensure that the correct type is installed.
may accumulate under the car when it has
been parked. This water is condensation Refrigerant
from the A/C system and is normal.
Volvo cares about the environment. The air Display
conditioning system in your car contains a The display above the climate control panel
Ice and snow CFC-free refrigerant R134a. This substance shows the climate settings that have been
will not deplete the ozone layer. The system made.
Always keep the air intake grille at the base of
contains 1.2 lbs (530 g) R134a (HFC 134a), and
the windshield free of snow.
uses PAG oil.
Personal settings
There are two functions in the climate system
that can be set to your preferences:
Blower speed to Auto mode (models with
ECC only).
Timer controlled recirculation of the air in
the passenger compartment.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

92
03 Climate

General information

For information about how to make these set- closed. If you drive with the windows or moon-
tings, see the Personal settings section on roof open, it may be preferable to manually
page 83. adjust the temperature and blower control (the
LED in the AUTO switch should be off).
Models equipped with ECC (option) Acceleration
Sensors The air conditioning system is temporarily 03
switched off during full throttle acceleration.
The sunlight sensor is on the upper side of
the dashboard
The passenger compartment temperature
sensor is located behind the climate sys-
tem control panel.
The ambient temperature sensor is in the
driver's side door mirror.
The humidity sensor is in the rearview mir-
ror.
These sensors should never be obstructed.

NOTE
The sunlight sensor monitors the side of the
vehicle from which the sun shines into the
passenger compartment. This means that
the temperature may differ slightly between
the left and right air vents, even if the climate
system temperature is set to be the same
for both sides of the passenger compart-
ment.

Side windows and optional moonroof


The electronic climate control system will func-
tion best if the windows and moonroof are

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

93
03 Climate

Air vents

Air vents in the dashboard

03

G019942

Open
Closed
Horizontal air flow
Vertical air flow
Direct the outer air vents toward the side win-
dows to defrost.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

94
03 Climate

Manual climate control

03

G019515
Climate system control panel
Blower speed Manual climate system functions 2. Recirculation
This function can be used to
Recirculation 1. Blower shut out exhaust fumes,
The blower speed can be smoke, etc from the passen-
Defroster
increased or decreased by ger compartment. The air in
Airflow controls turning the knob. If the knob is the passenger compartment
turned counterclockwise and is then recirculated, i.e. no air
A/C ON/OFF the indicator light in the dis- from outside the car is taken
Heated driver's seat play goes out, the blower and into the car when this function is activated.
the air conditioning are Recirculation (together with the air condition-
Heated front passenger's seat switched off. The display shows the blower ing system) cools the passenger compartment
symbol and OFF. more quickly in very warm weather. If the air in
Rear window and door mirror defrosters
the car recirculates for too long, there is a risk
Temperature selector of condensation forming on the insides of the
windows, especially in winter.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

95
03 Climate

Manual climate control

Timer 4. Airflow controls Reduced heating: Press the button a second


The timer function minimizes the risk of mist- Press one of the three buttons time one LED lights up.
ing, or stale air when the recirculation function in the illustration to activate Seat heating off: Press the button a third time
is selected, see page 83 for information on set- the selected airflow. A symbol no LEDs are lit.
ting the recirculation timer. Recirculation is in the display above the cli-
always disengaged when you select Defroster mate control panel and a lit 8. Heated rear window and door mirrors
03 (3). LED in the selected button Press to defrost the rear win-
indicate that the manual func- dow and door mirrors.
3. Defroster tion has been selected. With manually selected
Directs airflow to the wind- The rear window and door
airflow both warm and cool air can be selected.
shield and side windows and mirrors are defrosted simulta-
The desired temperature is selected using con-
increases blower speed. neously if the switch is
trol 9.
pressed once. The defrost
5. A/C On or Off function is active if the LED in the switch is illu-
ON: The air conditioning sys- minated.
tem is engaged when the ON The function can be switched off manually
When the defroster is activated:
light is lit. by pressing the button,
Air flows to the windows at high blower
OFF: The system is disen- The defrost function switches off automat-
speed.
gaged when the OFF lights ically after 1220 minutes, depending on
The LED in the defroster button lights up up. the outside temperature.
when this function is activated. The air con-
ditioning system is controlled to provide If Defroster (3) is activated the air conditioning
is always engaged. NOTE
maximum air dehumidification.
On certain markets, the defrost function
The air conditioning is automatically 6/7. Heated front seats (option) may remain on longer than 20 minutes in
switched on (can be switched off by press- Maximum heating: Press the cold weather to help keep the rear window
ing button 5). button once both LEDs light free from ice or condensation.
up.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

96
03 Climate

Manual climate control

9. Temperature selector
The knob with the thermome-
ter symbol is used to select
cooling or heating for both the
driver's and passenger's
sides of the car.
03

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

97
03 Climate

Electronic Climate Control (ECC) option

03

G019518
Auto On/Off ECC functions 2. Blower speed
The blower speed can be
Blower speed 1. Auto On/Off increased or decreased by
Recirculation The AUTO function automat- turning the knob. The blower
ically regulates climate con- speed is regulated automati-
Defroster trol to maintain the desired cally if AUTO is selected. The
temperature. The automatic previously set blower speed is
Airflow controls function controls heating, air disconnected.
A/C ON/OFF conditioning, blower speed,
recirculation, and air distribu-
Heated driver's seat
NOTE
tion.
If the knob is turned counterclockwise and
Heated front passenger's seat If you select one or more manual functions, the the blower indication in the display goes
remaining functions continue to be controlled out, the blower and the air conditioning are
Rear window and door mirror defrosters automatically. All manual settings are switched switched off. The display shows the blower
Temperature selector off when AUTO is switched on. AUTO symbol and OFF.
CLIMATE is shown in the display.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

98
03 Climate

Electronic Climate Control (ECC) option

3. Recirculation 4. Defroster 6. Air conditioning On/Off


This function can be used to Directs airflow to the wind- ON: The air conditioning sys-
shut out exhaust fumes, shield and side windows and tem is engaged when the ON
smoke, etc from the passen- increases blower speed. light is lit and is controlled
ger compartment. The air in When the defroster is acti- automatically by the system
the passenger compartment vated: to maintain the selected tem-
is then recirculated, i.e. no air perature. 03
from outside the car is taken
into the car when this function is activated. Air flows to the windows at high blower OFF: The system is disengaged when the
speed. OFF lights up
If the air in the car recirculates for too long,
The LED in the defroster button lights up When OFF is selected and the OFF LED is lit,
there is a risk of condensation forming on the when this function is activated. The air con-
insides of the windows, especially in winter. the air conditioning system is deactivated.
ditioning system is controlled to provide Other functions are still controlled automati-
maximum air dehumidification. cally.
Timer
The timer function minimizes the risk of fogging The air conditioning is automatically
When Defroster (4) is selected, the air condi-
or stale air when the recirculation function is switched on (can be switched off by press-
ing button 6). tioning system is activated for maximum dehu-
selected, see page 83 for information on set- midifying.
ting the recirculation timer. The air is not recirculated.
7 and 8. Heated front seats (option)
5. Airflow controls Maximum heating: Press the
NOTE
Press one of the three buttons button once both LEDs light
Recirculation is always disengaged if the in the illustration to activate up.
defroster button is engaged to clear ice or the selected airflow. A symbol
condensation from the side windows. in the display above the cli- Reduced heating: Press the
mate control panel and a lit button a second time one
LED in the selected button LED lights up.
indicate that the manual func- Seat heating off: Press the button a third time
tion has been selected. With manually selected no LEDs are lit.
airflow both warm and cool air can be selected.
See also the table on page 99.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

99
03 Climate

Electronic Climate Control (ECC) option

9. Rear window and door mirror 10. Temperature selector


defrosters The temperatures on the driv-
Press to defrost the rear win- er's and passenger's sides
dow and door mirrors. can be set separately using
the knob (with the thermome-
The rear window and door
ter in it). The temperature can
mirrors are defrosted simulta-
03 be set for both sides of the car
neously if the switch is
when the ignition is switched
pressed once. The defrost
on (both LEDs will be on), which means that a
function is active if the LED in the switch is illu-
temperature setting will apply to both sides of
minated.
the car.
The function can be switched off manually
To set the temperature on one side of the car:
by pressing the button.
The defrost function switches off automat- 1. Press the knob once. The LED for one side
ically after 1220 minutes, depending on of the car will light up. Turn the knob to
the outside temperature. adjust the temperature.
2. Press the knob a second time to set the
NOTE temperature on the opposite side of the
car.
On certain markets, the defrost function
may remain on longer than 20 minutes 3. Press the knob a third time to set the tem-
in cold weather to help keep the rear perature on both sides of the car at the
window free from ice or condensation. same time.

NOTE
Selecting a temperature that is higher or
lower than necessary will not heat or cool
the passenger compartment faster.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

100
03 Climate

Air distribution

Air distribution Use: Air distribution Use:


Defroster. Defrost/de-fog the wind- Air to the floor and win- For comfortable condi-
shield and front side win- dows. tions and good defrosting
Air is not recirculated in
dows. in cold weather.
this mode. There is also a certain
amount of airflow to the Medium to high blower
Air conditioning is always 03
dashboard air vents. speed.
engaged.
There is also a certain
amount of airflow to the
panel air vents.

Air to windshield and front Prevents fogging in cold Air to the floor and from For sunny weather with
side windows. or humid weather (blower the dashboard air vents. cool ambient tempera-
speed should be moder- tures.
There is also a certain
ate to high).
amount of airflow to the
dashboard air vents.

Air to the windows and For good comfort in Air to the floor. To warm the feet.
from the dashboard air warm, dry weather.
There is a certain amount
vents.
of airflow to the dash-
board and window air
vents.

Airflow directed to the To ensure efficient cooling Airflow to the windows, For cooler air toward the
head and chest from the in a warm weather. dashboard air vents, and feet, or for warmer air
dashboard air vents. floor. toward the head and
chest.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

101
Front seats............................................................................................ 104
Interior lighting...................................................................................... 107
Storage compartments......................................................................... 109
Rear seat............................................................................................... 113

G020908
Trunk .................................................................................................... 115

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

102
INTERIOR

04
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
04 Interior

Front seats

Manual seat adjustment Turn this knob to adjust the backrest tilt. Folding down the front seat backrests
Control panel for power seats.

WARNING
Do not adjust the seat while driving.
Adjust the drivers seat and seat belt
(see page 18) before driving. The seat
should be adjusted so that the brake
pedal can be depressed fully.
04
Position the seat as far rearward as
G027960 comfort and control allow.

G014805
The driver's and passenger's seats can be The front passenger's seat backrest can be
adjusted in a number of ways to provide a folded down to provide room for long loads.
comfortable driving and sitting position.
1. Move the seat as far back as possible.
Forward-rearward: Pull the lever up and
2. Adjust the backrest to the upright position.
slide the seat to the position of your choice.
3. Lift the catches on the rear of the backrest
Use this control to raise or lower the front
as shown in the illustration.
edge of the seat cushion.
Use this control to raise or lower the rear 4. Without releasing the catches, push the
edge of the seat cushion. backrest forward.
Turn this knob (option on some passeng- 5. Move the seat as far forward as possible
er's seats) to adjust the firmness of the so that the head restraint slides under the
lumbar support1. glove compartment.

1 Also applies to the optional power seat.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

104
04 Interior

Front seats

WARNING Adjusting the seat NOTE


Cover sharp edges on the load to help pre- The power seats have an overload protector
vent injury to occupants. Secure the load to that activates if a seat is blocked by any
help prevent shifting during sudden stops. object. If this occurs, switch off the ignition
(key in position 0) and wait for approxi-
mately 20 seconds before operating the
Power seats (option) seat again.
The power driver's seat can be adjusted:
Emergency stop
If the ignition key is in position I or II.
If the seat inadvertently begins to move, press
During a 10 minute period after the doors any of the buttons to stop the seat. 04
have been unlocked if the door remains
open. Programming the seat memory, driver's

G020199
If the door is closed and the ignition key is seat only (option)
not yet in the ignition, or if the key is in
position 0, the seat can be adjusted or dur- Seat adjustment controls
ing a period of 40 seconds. The power
passenger's seat can only be adjusted if Seat adjustment controls 1, 2, 3, and 4 on the
the ignition key is in position I or II, or if the side of the seat can be used to move the seat
engine is running. to the position of your choice.
Move this section of the control up or down
to raise/lower the front section of the seat
cushion.
Move the control forward/rearward to
move the seat forward or rearward.
Move this section of the control up or down

G020200
to raise/lower the rear section of the seat
cushion.
Power seat memory buttons
Backrest tilt.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

105
04 Interior

Front seats

Three different seating positions can be stored 1. Adjust the seat to the desired position. WARNING
in the seat's memory. The memory buttons are
2. When you leave the car, lock it using the Because the driver's seat can be
located on the outboard side of the driver's
remote control. adjusted with the ignition off, children
seat (see the illustration above). The following
example explains how memory button 1 can be 3. The next time the driver's door is unlocked should never be left unattended in the
programmed. Buttons 2 and 3 can be pro- with the same remote control and that door car.
grammed in the same way. is opened within 2 minutes, the driver's Movement of the seat can be STOPPED
seat and side door mirrors will automati- at any time by pressing any button on
To program (store) a seat position in memory the power seat control panel.
cally move to the position that they were in
button 1:
when the doors were most recently locked Do not adjust the seat while driving. The
1. Adjust the seat to the desired position. with the same remote control. seat should be adjusted so that the
04 brake pedal can be depressed fully. In
2. Press and hold down the "M" (Memory)
button. NOTE addition, position the seat as far rear-
ward as comfort and control allow.
3. With the "M" button depressed, press The memory function in the remote control
memory button 1 to store the seat's current operates independently the memory func- The seat rails on the floor must not be
tion in the seat. obstructed in any way when the seat is
position.
in motion.
To move the seat to the position that it was in
when memory button 1 was programmed,
press and hold down button 1 until the seat
stops moving.
As a safety precaution, the seat will stop auto-
matically if the button is released before the
seat has reached the preset position.

Central locking system remote control


and driver's seat memory
The remote control transmitter can also be
equipped with an optional function that con-
trols the electrically operated driver's seat in
the following way:

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

106
04 Interior

Interior lighting

Interior lighting Press the left side of the button: the interior If the courtesy lighting is not switched off man-
courtesy lighting turns on. ually, it will be turned off automatically
Neutral position: the interior courtesy light- 5 minutes after the engine has been switched
ing comes on when a door is opened, and off.
is switched off 10 seconds after the door is
closed. Footwell lighting
The footwell (and courtesy lighting) comes on
Press the right side of the button: the inte-
or goes off when one of the side doors is
rior courtesy lighting stays off.
opened or closed.

Courtesy lighting automatic function


Rear reading lights 04
The interior lighting has a built-in automatic
G020201 function that switches on the courtesy lighting
for 30 seconds when:
the car is unlocked from the outside using
the key or remote control
Front courtesy lights and reading lights
Front driver's side reading light, on/off the engine is switched off and the ignition
key is turned to the 0 position.
Courtesy lighting The courtesy lighting lights up or remains on
Front passenger's side reading light, on/off for 5 minutes when:

The front and rear reading lights can be acti- one of the doors is opened and left open.
vated when the ignition key is position I or II, or the courtesy lighting has not been

G020763
when the engine is running. The front reading switched off (the right side of button 2
lights are switched on and off by pressing but- depressed).
tons (1) or (3). The automatic lighting goes out when: Rear reading lights (in ceiling)
The courtesy lighting (2) can be set to three the engine is started Rear driver's side reading light, on/off
positions: the car is locked from the outside using the Rear passenger's side reading light, on/off
key or remote control.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

107
04 Interior

Interior lighting

The rear reading lights can be switched on or


off by pressing the respective buttons, and
function if the ignition key is in positions I, II, or
if the engine is running.
The courtesy lighting can be switched on or off
within 30 minutes after the engine has been
switched off, or after a door has been opened
or closed.
These lights switch off automatically 5 minutes
after the engine has been switched off.
04

Vanity mirror G020210

Raise the cover to switch on the light.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

108
04 Interior

Storage compartments

04

G026508
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

109
04 Interior

Storage compartments

Storage pocket (on the rear side of the front Glove compartment Jacket hanger
seats)
Compartment in door panel
Storage pocket (on the front side of the
front seat cushion)
Glove compartment
Storage compartment for e.g., CDs and
cup holders
Jacket hanger (intended for light garments
04
only)
Rear seat storage compartment and cup

G024208

G018137
holders
Storage pocket (on the front side of the
rear, center seat cushion).
The owners manual and maps can be stored The jacket hanger is located on the inboard
here. There are also holders for coins, pens and side of the front passenger's seat head
WARNING fuel cards. The glove compartment can only be restraint. It is only intended for hanging light
Anchor any heavy objects to prevent locked and unlocked using the detachable key garments.
them from moving during sudden stops. blade from the central locking system's remote
control. See page 120 for information on
Packages on the rear parcel shelf can
removing the key blade from the remote con-
obscure vision and may become dan-
gerous projectiles in the event of a sud- trol, and page 128 for information about lock-
den stop or an accident. ing the glove compartment.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

110
04 Interior

Storage compartments

Storage under the front, center armrest CD storage Cup holders in the center console

04

G026704
G018371

G018372
There are two storage compartments under the The deep storage compartment has room for Two cup holders are located under the sliding
front, center armrest. 10 CD jewel cases. These cases must be cover in the center console.
inserted with their spines upward in order to
Press the smaller button on the front edge
allow space for 10 cases in the storage com- The cup holders can be lifted out if necessary.
of the armrest and lift the armrest cover to To do so, grasp the indentation on the rear
partment
access a shallow storage compartment. edge of the cup holder and lift.
Press the larger button and lift the entire To put the cup holder back in place:
armrest to access a deeper compartment.
1. Slide the two locating tabs in the front side
of the cup holder into the two correspond-
ing recesses in the center console storage
space.
2. Press down the rear edge of the cup
holder.
To close the sliding cover, grasp the underside
of the front edge and pull.
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

111
04 Interior

Storage compartments

Storage compartment behind the gear


lever

04
G019623

If the buttons for optional equipment are not


installed, the recess behind the gear lever can
be used as a storage compartment for coins,
etc.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

112
04 Interior

Rear seat

Rear seat head restraints To raise: Slide the head restraint up to the seat belts can be attached to the clothes hook
desired height. as shown in the illustration.
To lower: Press the catch at the base of the
right support and press the head restraint NOTE
down.
When the seat backs are folded down, the
To remove: Pull the head restraint up far as head restraints may be damaged if they are
possible. Press the catch at the base of the not removed. The center head restraint
right support and pull the head restraint out must also be removed when transporting
of the its holders. heavy loads.

Folding down the rear seat backrests 04


G020765

Adjust the head restraint vertically


Each of the rear seat head restraints can be
adjusted vertically to suit the height of the pas-
senger. The upper edge of the head restraint
should be on a level with the midpoint of the
rear side of the passenger's head (see illustra-
tion).

G014845
G020790
WARNING
Rear edge of seat cushion
The center rear seat head restraint should
only be in its lowest position when this seat Both sections of the rear seat backrest can be Catch
is NOT occupied. When the center position folded down, together or separately, to enable
is occupied, the head restraint should be Folding down the backrest
correctly adjusted to the passengers you to transport long objects. Before folding
height. down the rear seat backrests, the outboard Location of the head restraint in the seat
cushion
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

113
04 Interior

Rear seat

To fold down one or both sections: WARNING


1. Grasp the rear edge of the seat cushion The red lock indicator is VISIBLE when
and pull it forward. the backrest is NOT locked in position
2. Pull the catch on the upper outboard edge and hidden when the backrest is cor-
of the backrest upward and forward to rectly locked in place. When the back-
release the backrest lock. A red lock indi- rest is in the upright position, it must
cator is visible when the backrest is not always be correctly locked in place.
locked in the upright position. When the rear seat is folded down, do
3. Fold the backrest down partially and not place heavy objects against the
remove the outboard head restraints. backs of the front seats. This places a
04 severe strain on the folded down back-
Press the center head restraint down com-
rest of the rear seat. Be sure to secure
pletely or remove it.
cargo.
4. Place the head restraints in the plastic
tubes, which are now accessible on the
Cargo must not be stacked higher than
the top of seat backs. This will reduce
under side of the seat cushions. the possibility of luggage, etc. becom-
ing projectiles during sudden maneu-
NOTE vers, rapid braking or an accident.
When folding down the rear seat backrests,
remove the plug in the rear 12 volt socket to
help avoid marks in the upholstery.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

114
04 Interior

Trunk

Load anchoring eyelets

04
G018099

The eyelets in the trunk can be used to fasten


accessory load and lashing straps, load nets,
and other load anchors.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

115
Remote control and key blade.............................................................. 118
Valet locking ......................................................................................... 122
Keyless drive (option as available)........................................................ 123
Locking and unlocking.......................................................................... 127
Child safety locks.................................................................................. 129
Alarm (option)........................................................................................ 130

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

116
LOCKS AND ALARM

05
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
05 Locks and alarm

Remote control and key blade

Remote controls mum of six remote controls/key blades can be CAUTION


Two remote controls that also function as igni- programmed and used for one car.
Never use force on the narrow section of the
tion keys are provided with your car. The remote control this is where the trans-
remote controls contain detachable metal key Immobilizer (start inhibitor) ponder is located. The car cannot be started
blades for manually locking or unlocking the Each of the keys supplied with your car con- if the transponder is damaged.
driver's door and the glove compartment. tains a coded transponder. The code in the key
USA FCC ID: LTQVO315TX is transmitted to an antenna in the ignition
switch where it is compared to the code stored Remote control functions
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
in the start inhibitor module. The car will start
rules. Operation is subject to the following con-
only with a properly coded key. If you misplace
ditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful
a key, take the other keys to an authorized
interference, and (2) this device must accept
Volvo retailer for reprogramming as an antitheft
any interference received, including interfer-
measure.
ence that may cause undesired operation.
USA FCC ID: LTQWFS 125VO
Canada IC: 3659AVO315TX
05
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
Operation is subject to the following condi-
rules. Operation is subject to the following con-
tions: (1) this device may not cause interfer-
dition: (1) This device may not cause harmful
ence, and (2) this device must accept any
interference, and (2) this device must accept
interference, including interference that may
any interference received, including interfer-
cause undesired operation of the device.

G019402
ence that may cause undesired operation.
Canada IC: 3659A-WFS125VO
Loss of a remote control
If either of the remote controls is lost, the other Operation is subject to the following condi- Lock Press the Lock button on the
must be taken with the car to a Volvo retailer. tions: (1) this device may not cause interfer- remote once to lock all doors and the trunk.
As an anti-theft measure, the code of the lost ence, and (2) this device must accept any The turn signals will flash once to confirm
remote control must be erased from the sys- interference, including interference that may locking.
tem. cause undesired operation of the device.

Each key blade has a unique code, which is


used if new key blades are required. A maxi-

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

118
05 Locks and alarm

Remote control and key blade

NOTE NOTE Approach lighting As you approach the


car: Press the button on the remote control
The car can also be locked if a door is open The turn signals flash to confirm that the to illuminate the area around the car in dark
(does not apply to vehicles with the optional vehicle has been correctly locked/ conditions. Pressing the button once lights
keyless drive). unlocked with the remote control or the up the interior lighting, parking lights, and
optional keyless drive. When locking the license plate lighting. These lights will
Unlock Press the Unlock button on the vehicle, the turn signals will flash a con-
switch off automatically after 30, 60 or
remote once to unlock the driver's door. firmation only if all the doors are
90 seconds. See the Personal settings pa
After a short pause, press the Unlock but- securely closed and locked. Flashing
ge 83 for information about adjusting the
ton a second time within 10 seconds to confirmation for locking and unlocking
may be customized in the vehicle's Per- time setting.
unlock the other doors and the trunk. A
sonal settings menu, see page 83 for Unlock trunk Press the button once to
long press (at least several seconds) opens
more information. disarm the alarm system and unlock only
all side windows.
The two-step unlocking function can be the trunk. After closing, the trunk will not
changed so that one press of the automatically relock. Press Lock to relock
Unlock button unlocks all of the doors it and rearm the alarm.
05
and the trunk. See Personal settings
page 83 for more information. NOTE
This function will unlock, but not pop open,
Automatic relocking: If the doors are the trunk.
unlocked, the locks will automatically reen-
gage (re-lock) and the alarm will rearm after
Panic alarm This button can be used to
2 minutes unless a door or the trunk has
attract attention during emergency situa-
been opened.
tions. To activate the panic alarm, press
Automatic locking: When the car starts to and hold the red button for at least 3 sec-
move, the doors and trunk can be locked onds or press it twice within 3 seconds.
automatically. This feature can be turned The turn signals and horn will be activated.
on or off, see Personal settings on page The panic alarm will stop automatically
83 for more information.
after 30 seconds. To deactivate, wait
Airbag deployment will automatically approximately 5 seconds and press the red
attempt to unlock the doors. button again.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

119
05 Locks and alarm

Remote control and key blade

NOTE Replacing the battery in the remote Key blade


control
This button will NOT unlock the car.
If the range of the transmitter is noticeably
reduced, this indicates that the battery (type
Weak battery in the remote control CR 2450, 3V) is weak and should be replaced.
To replace the battery:
1. Place the remote control with the keypad
downward. Pry open the cover with a small
slotted screwdriver.
2. Remove the cover.

CAUTION

G019403
When replacing the battery, avoid touching
05 the electrical circuitry in the other half of the
remote control. Removing the key blade
The key blade can be removed from the remote
G019406

3. Note how the + and sides of the battery control. When removed, it can be used as fol-
are positioned on the inside of the cover lows:
(see the underside of the cover).
When the battery begins to lose its charge, the To lock/unlock the drivers door
4. Pry out and replace the battery. Avoid
Information symbol in the instrument panel
touching the battery and its contact surfa-
To lock/unlock the glove compartment,
(see page 55) lights up and KEY BATTERY see page 128
ces with your fingers.
LOW VOLTAGE is shown in the information For valet locking (see page 122)
display. 5. Press the cover back into place.
Removing the key blade
The old battery should be disposed of properly
Slide the spring loaded catch to the side.
at a recycling center or by a trained and quali-
fied Volvo service technician. While holding the catch, pull the key blade
out of the remote control.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

120
05 Locks and alarm

Remote control and key blade

Reinserting the key blade in the remote 2. Turn the key blade one-quarter turn coun-
control ter-clockwise to lock the driver's door.
1. Hold the remote control with the pointed
end down.
2. Carefully slide the key blade into its groove.
3. Gently press the key blade in the groove
until it clicks into place.

Unlocking the doors with the detached


key blade
Insert the key blade as far as possible in the
driver's door lock. Turn the key blade
clockwise approximately one-quarter turn
to unlock the driver's door only.
05
NOTE
After unlocking the driver's door with the
key blade, opening the door will trigger the
alarm.

To disable the alarm


Press the Unlock button on the remote control,
or insert the key in the ignition switch.

Locking the doors with the detached key


blade
1. Lock the other door(s) by pressing the lock
button on each door. Please note that this
does not arm the alarm or lock the trunk.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

121
05 Locks and alarm

Valet locking

Locking points Turn the key blade 180 clockwise to lock


the glove compartment and disconnect the
trunk from the central locking system (a mes-
sage appears in the information display)

G033839
G000000

Remote control: Locking/unlocking points with


05 key blade removed (with valet locking activated)
Remote control: Normal locking/unlocking points

G020032
By utilizing the remote control without the key Give the parking attendant or service person-
blade, the valet locking feature enables you to nel only the remote control (with the key blade
block access to the trunk and glove compart- removed).
Activating/deactivating the valet locking function
ment for e.g., valet parking or when the car is Deactivating valet locking:
Remove the key blade from the glove com-
brought to the retailer for service.
partment lock. Turn the key blade 180 counterclockwise in
To use the valet locking function, begin by the glove compartment lock to deactivate valet
removing the key blade from the remote con- The rear seat backrests must also be locked in
locking (the trunk can then be unlocked using
trol (see page 120). the upright position.
the remote control). Then use the key blade to
Drivers side: Turn the key clockwise in the unlock the rear seat backrests.
Activating valet locking:
lock on the upper outboard edge of the back-
Insert the key blade in the glove compart- rest.
ment lock. Passengers side: Turn the key counterclock-
wise in the lock on the upper outboard edge of
the backrest.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

122
05 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive (option as available)

Keyless locking and unlocking Both of the remote controls provided with the Locking the vehicle
vehicle have the keyless function, and addi-
tional remotes can be ordered. The system can
accommodate up to six keyless drive remote
controls.

NOTE
The number of doors that are unlocked at
the same time can be set in the Personal
settings menu, see page 83 for additional
information.

Unlocking the vehicle

G020033
G019423

A keyless drive remote control must be on


the same side of the vehicle as the door to
05
Range of the keyless drive remote control5 ft be opened, and be within 5 feet Keyless drive lock button
(1.5 meters) (1.5 meters) of the lock or the trunk opening The doors and the trunk can be locked by
control (see the shaded areas in the illus-
This system makes it possible to unlock and pressing the lock button in any of the outside
tration).
lock the vehicle without having to use the door handles.
remote control. It is only necessary to have a Pull a door handle to unlock and open the
keyless drive remote control in your posses- door or press the trunk opening control.
NOTE
sion to operate the central locking system. See page 146 for information on starting a
vehicle equipped with keyless drive. If one or more doors and/or the trunk is
not fully closed when the lock button is
NOTE pressed, the door(s) or trunk will not be
The buttons on the keyless drive remote locked.
control can also be used to lock and unlock On keyless drive vehicles with an auto-
the vehicle, see page 118 for more informa- matic transmission, the gear selector
tion.
must be in the Park (P) position and the
ignition must be switched off before the
doors/trunk can be locked.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

123
05 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive (option as available)

Locking or unlocking the vehicle with the to unlock the driver's door only. This will NOTE
key blade trigger the alarm.
If several people carrying keyless drive
To disable the alarm: Press the Unlock remote controls approach the vehicle at the
button on the keyless drive remote control. same time, the driver's seat will assume the
If the batteries in the remote are weak, position it was in for the person who opens
remove the keyless drive start control from a door first.
the ignition switch by pressing the catch
(see the illustration on page 146) and pull-
ing the control out of the ignition switch. Keyless drive information messages
Insert the ignition key section of a keyless If anyone leaves the vehicle with the only key-
drive remote control in the ignition switch. less drive remote control in his or her posses-
sion while the ignition is switched on, a
Keyless drive remote control and driver's message will be shown in the information dis-
seat memory play and an audible signal will sound.
This function is only available on vehicles
G020225

05 equipped with the optional power driver's seat. NOTE


Keyless drive keyhole cover
When you leave the car with a keyless drive This message will only be displayed if the
remote control in your possession and lock start control is in position I or II.
The driver's door on vehicles equipped with any door, the position of the driver's seat
keyless drive can be locked or unlocked with will be stored in the seat's memory.
The message will be erased from the display
the remote control's detachable key blade if The next time a door is opened by a person and the audible signal will stop when the
necessary, see page 120 for information on with the same remote control in his/her remote control has been returned to the vehicle
removing the key blade from the remote con- possession, the driver's seat will automat- and one of the following has occurred:
trol. To access the keyhole in the driver's door: ically move to the position that it was in
when the door was most recently locked. A door has been opened and closed
Pry off the keyhole cover by inserting the
key blade or a small screwdriver in the hole The start control has been turned to posi-
on the underside of the cover (indicated by tion 0
the arrow in the inset illustration). The READ button (see page 60 for the
Insert the key blade as far as possible in the location of this button) has been pressed.
driver's door lock. Turn the key blade
clockwise approximately one-quarter turn

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

124
05 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive (option as available)

CAUTION KR55WK48964 Location of the keyless drive antennas


Keyless drive remote controls should NOTE
never be left in the vehicle. In the event This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
of a break-in, a remote found in the Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
vehicle could make it possible to start conditions: (1) This device may not cause
the engine. harmful interference, and (2) this device must
Electromagnetic fields or metal accept interference received, including inter-
obstructions can interfere with the key- ference that may cause undesired operation.
less drive system. Avoid placing the
remote control near cellular phones, CAUTION
metallic objects or e.g., in a metal brief- Changes or modifications not expressly
case. approved by the manufacturer could void the
user's authority to operate the equipment.

G020076
Canada IC:267T- 5WK48952, Siemens VDO
05
267T- 5WK48964, 267T-5WK48891 5WK48891
The keyless drive system has a number of
NOTE Tested To Comply With FCC Standards antennas located at various points in the vehi-
This device complies with RSS -210 of Industry For Automobile Use cle.
Canada. Operation is subject to the following On the inside center of the rear bumper
two conditions: (1) This device may not cause
harmful interference, and (2) this device must Left rear door handle
accept interference received, including inter-
ference that may cause undesired operation. Under the floor of the trunk, near the rear
seat
CAUTION
Right rear door handle
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the manufacturer could void the Under the rear section of the center con-
user's authority to operate the equipment. sole
Under the front section of the center con-
USA FCC ID:KR55WK48952,
sole

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

125
05 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive (option as available)

WARNING
People with implanted pacemakers should
not allow the pacemaker to come closer
than 9 inches (22 cm) to any of the keyless
drive system's antennas. This is to help pre-
vent interference between the pacemaker
and the keylesss drive system.

05

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

126
05 Locks and alarm

Locking and unlocking

Locking/unlocking the vehicle from the NOTE Opening the trunk from the inside2
inside
The ignition key must be in position I or
higher (see page 143) before all side
windows can be opened using the
switches in the front doors.
The doors cannot be opened by pulling
up the lock buttons.
Each door can also be locked manually
using the lock button on that particular
door. This applies only if the car has not
been locked from the outside.
The doors can also be unlocked (and

G030709
the door opened) by pulling the handle
G007451

in the door twice.


05
The vehicle is equipped with a florescent han-
The switches near the door opening handles on dle on the inside of the trunk lid, which can be
the driver's and front passenger's doors can be used in an emergency situation to open the
used to lock or unlock all doors and the trunk, trunk from the inside.
open the side windows1, and to set the alarm. Pull the handle down to release the trunk lid.
Unlocking: Press the upper section of the After use, the handle must be pushed back into
switch. A long press (for several seconds) its original position before the trunk can be
also opens all the side windows. closed.
Locking: Press the lower section of the
lock button.

1 This function must be set to On in the Personal settings menu (see page 84)
2 U.S. models only
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

127
05 Locks and alarm

Locking and unlocking

Locking the glove compartment

G020034

05
The glove compartment can only be locked
and unlocked using the detachable key blade
on the remote control, see page 120 for infor-
mation on removing the key blade from the
remote control.
Insert the key blade in the glove compart-
ment lock.
Turn the key blade 90 degrees clockwise.
The key slot will be in the horizontal posi-
tion.
Remove the key blade from the lock.

Unlock the glove compartment in the reverse


order.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

128
05 Locks and alarm

Child safety locks

Manual child safety locks, rear doors

G014697

05
The controls are located on the rear inside
edges of the doors, and are only accessible
when the doors are open.
1. Remove the key blade from the remote
control, see page 120.
2. Turn the control with the key blade.
The door cannot be opened from the
inside.
The door can be opened from the inside.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

129
05 Locks and alarm

Alarm (option)

The alarm system The alarm indicator light Fault in the alarm system: If a fault has
The alarm is automatically armed whenever the been detected in the alarm system, a mes-
car is locked with the remote control, or if a sage will be shown in the information dis-
front lock button is depressed. play. Contact your Volvo retailer to have
the alarm system inspected and repaired if
When armed, the alarm continuously monitors necessary.
a number of points on the car. The following
conditions will trigger the alarm:
Arming the alarm
The hood is forced open. Press the LOCK button on the remote control,
The trunk is forced open. or press the central lock button on one of the
A door is forced open. front doors with the door open. One long flash
of the turn signals will confirm that the alarm is
The ignition switch is tampered with
armed.

G020227
An attempt is made to start the car with a
non-approved key (a key not coded to the
05 car's ignition). Disarming the alarm
Alarm indicator light Press the UNLOCK button on the remote con-
If there is movement in the passenger com-
partment (if the car is equipped with the The status of the alarm system is indicated by trol or insert the key in the ignition1 to disarm
optional movement sensor). the indicator light on at the top of the dash- the alarm. Two short flashes from the car's
board (see the illustration): direction indicators confirm that the alarm has
The car is lifted or towed (if the car is equip-
been deactivated and that all doors are
ped with the optional inclination sensor) Indicator light off the alarm is not armed
unlocked.
The battery is disconnected (while the The indicator light flashes every two sec-
alarm is armed). onds the alarm is armed
The siren is disconnected when the alarm The indicator light flashes rapidly before
is disarmed. the ignition is switched on the alarm has
been triggered. The message "ALARM
TRIGGERED, CHECK CAR" will also be
displayed.

1 On vehicles with the optional keyless drive, press in the start control in the ignition switch.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

130
05 Locks and alarm

Alarm (option)

Turning off (stopping) the alarm Temporarily turning off the accessory In certain situations it may be desirable to turn
If the alarm is sounding, it can be stopped by alarm sensor(s) off the accessory inclination and movement
pressing the UNLOCK button on the remote alarm sensors if, for example, you drive your
control or by inserting the key in the ignition vehicle onto a ferry where the rocking of the
switch. The driver's door must first be boat could trigger the alarm or if a pet is left in
unlocked with the key blade. the vehicle with the doors locked.
To do so:
NOTE 1. Press MENU to enter the menu system and
On vehicles equipped with the optional key- scroll to Car settings (for a more detailed
less drive, the start control must be description of the menus, see page 83.
removed from the ignition switch before the
key can be inserted, see page 146 for 2. Select Reduced guard.
instructions.
3. Select Activate once and the message
Reduced guard See manual will
Audible/visual alarm signal appear in the information display. The 05
alarm sensors will be turned off when the
An audible alarm signal is given by a battery
vehicle is locked.
powered siren. The alarm cycle lasts for
30 seconds. or
Select Ask on exit. Each time the ignition
NOTE key is turned to position 0, the message

G026313
The visual alarm signal is given by flashing Press ENTER to reduce guard until
all turn signals and turning on the interior engine is started. Press EXIT to
lighting for approximately 5 minutes. Display cancel will be displayed. Select one of the
MENU alternatives:

EXIT if the alarm sensors are to be deactivated,


press ENTER and then lock the vehicle.
ENTER The next time the ignition key is turned to posi-
tion II, the sensors will be reactivated and Full
Menu navigation controls
guard will displayed.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

131
05 Locks and alarm

Alarm (option)

or
If you do not wish to deactivate the sensors, do
not choose an alternative and lock the vehicle
or press EXIT and lock the vehicle.

CAUTION
The accessory sensors are automati-
cally reconnected to the alarm system
the next time the vehicle is unlocked
and then locked again.
This function will not turn off the vehi-
cle's standard alarm.

05 U.S.A. FCC ID: MAYDA 5823(3)


This device complies with part 15 of the FCC
rules. Operation is subject to the following con-
ditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept
any interference received, including interfer-
ence that may cause undesired operation.
Canada IC: 4405A-DA 5823(3)
Movement sensor DA5823 by Dynex Operation
is subject to the following conditions: (1) this
device may not cause interference, and (2) this
device must accept any interference, including
interference that may cause undesired opera-
tion of the device.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

132
05 Locks and alarm

05

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

133
General information............................................................................... 136
Fuel requirements................................................................................. 140
Ignition switch....................................................................................... 143
Starting the vehicle............................................................................... 144
Starting the vehicle with keyless drive (option as available)................. 146
Manual transmission, 5-speed (certain markets only).......................... 147
Manual transmission, 6-speed (certain markets only).......................... 148
Automatic transmission (option)........................................................... 149
Shiftlock override.................................................................................. 151
All Wheel Drive (option)......................................................................... 152
Brake system........................................................................................ 153
Stability system..................................................................................... 155
Towing................................................................................................... 157
Jump starting........................................................................................ 159
Towing a trailer...................................................................................... 160
Detachable trailer hitch......................................................................... 162
Transporting loads................................................................................ 163
Blind Spot Information System (BLIS)option...................................... 164

G020912
Park assist (Option/accessory)............................................................. 168

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

134
STARTING AND DRIVING

06
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
06 Starting and driving

General information

Economical driving conserves natural Note that roof racks, ski racks, etc, WARNING
resources increase air resistance and also fuel con-
sumption. Driving with the trunk open: Driving with
Better driving economy may be obtained by the trunk open could lead to poisonous
thinking ahead, avoiding rapid starts and stops At highway driving speeds, fuel consump- exhaust gases entering the passenger com-
and adjusting the speed of your vehicle to tion will be lower with the air conditioning partment. If the trunk must be kept open for
immediate traffic conditions. on and the windows closed than with the any reason, proceed as follows:
air conditioning off and the windows open.
Observe the following rules: 1. Close the windows.
Using the onboard trip computer's fuel
2. Set the ventilation system control to air
Bring the engine to normal operating tem- consumption modes can help you learn
perature as soon as possible by driving how to drive more economically. flow to floor, windshield and side win-
with a light foot on the accelerator pedal for dows and the blower control to its high-
the first few minutes of operation. A cold Other factors that decrease gas mileage est setting.
engine uses more fuel and is subject to are:
increased wear. Dirty air cleaner
Weight distribution affects handling
Whenever possible, avoid using the vehicle Dirty engine oil and clogged oil filter
for driving short distances. This does not At the specified curb weight your vehicle has a
allow the engine to reach normal operating
Dragging brakes tendency to understeer, which means that the
temperature. Incorrect front end alignment steering wheel has to be turned more than
Some of the above mentioned items and others might seem appropriate for the curvature of a
Drive carefully and avoid rapid acceleration
bend. This ensures good stability and reduces
06 and hard braking. are checked at the standard maintenance
intervals. the risk of rear wheel skid. Remember that
Use the transmission's Drive (D) position these properties can alter with the vehicle load.
as often as possible and avoid using kick- The heavier the load in the cargo area, the less
down. the tendency to understeer.
Do not exceed posted speed limits.
Avoid carrying unnecessary items (extra
load) in the vehicle.
Maintain correct tire pressure. Check tire
pressure regularly (when tires are cold).
Remove snow tires when threat of snow or
ice has ended.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

136
06 Starting and driving

General information

Handling, roadholding CAUTION Volvo. Different types of antifreeze must


Vehicle load, tire design and inflation pressure not be mixed.
all affect vehicle handling. Therefore, check
Engine damage will occur if water is
Volvo recommends using only genuine
drawn into the air cleaner.
that the tires are inflated to the recommended Volvo antifreeze in your vehicle's radiator.
pressure according to the vehicle load. See the If the vehicle is driven through water Your Volvo retailer stocks plenty of Volvo
"Tire pressure" section. Loads should be dis- deeper than 9 in (25 cm), water may engine coolant to help protect your vehicle
tributed so that capacity weight or maximum enter the differential and the transmis- during cold weather.
sion. This reduces the oil's lubricating
permissible axle loads are not exceeded.
capacity and may shorten the service
Try to keep the fuel tank well filled this
prevents the formation of condensation in
life of these components.
the tank. In addition, in extremely cold
Driving through water Do not allow the vehicle to stand in weather conditions it is worthwhile to add
The vehicle can be driven through water up to water up to the door sills longer than fuel line de-icer before refueling.
a depth of approximately 9 in. (25 cm), at a absolutely necessary. This could result
maximum speed of 6 mph (10 km/h). in electrical malfunctions.
The viscosity of the engine oil is important.
Oil with low viscosity (thinner oil) improves
Take particular care when driving through If the engine has been stopped while the cold-weather starting as well as decreas-
flowing water. car is in water, do not attempt to restart ing fuel consumption while the engine is
the engine. Have the car towed out of warming up. For winter use, 5W-30 oil, par-
Clean the electrical connections for trailer
the water.
wiring after driving in mud or water ticularly the synthetic type1, is recom-
mended. Be sure to use good quality oil but
When driving through water, maintain low
do not use cold-weather oil for hard driving
speed and do not stop in the water. 06
Cold weather precautions or in warm weather, see page 269 for more
If you wish to check your vehicle before the information.
WARNING approach of cold weather, the following advice The load placed on the battery is greater
After driving through water, press lightly on is worth noting: during the winter since the windshield wip-
the brake pedal to ensure that the brakes ers, lighting, etc. are used more often.
are functioning normally. Water or mud can Make sure that the engine coolant contains
50 percent antifreeze. Any other mixture Moreover, the capacity of the battery
make the brake linings slippery, resulting in decreases as the temperature drops. In
delayed braking effect. will reduce freeze protection. This gives
protection against freezing down to 31 F very cold weather, a poorly charged bat-
(35 C). See section "Coolant". The use of tery can freeze and be damaged. It is there-
"recycled" antifreeze is not approved by fore advisable to check the state of charge

1 Synthetic oil is not used when the oil is changed at the normal maintenance intervals except at owner request and at additional charge. Please consult your Volvo retailer.
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

137
06 Starting and driving

General information

more frequently and spray an anti-rust oil Conserving electrical current NOTE
on the battery posts. Keep the following in mind to help minimize
Volvo recommends the use of snow tires battery drain:
If the ignition is switched on, a warning
message will be displayed in the text
on all four wheels for winter driving see
the chapter "Wheels and tires." When the engine is not running, avoid turn- window in the instrument panel when
ing the ignition key to position II. Many the battery charge is low.
To prevent the washer fluid reservoir from electrical systems (the audio system, the An energy conserving function
freezing, add washer solvents containing optional navigation system, power win- designed into the vehicle's electrical
antifreeze (see page 215 for the location of dows, etc) will function with the ignition key system will switch off certain functions
the washer fluid reservoir). This is impor- in position I. This position reduces drain on or reduce the load on the battery by,
tant since dirt is often splashed on the the battery. e.g., reducing the audio system's vol-
windshield during winter driving, requiring
the frequent use of the washers and wip- Please keep in mind that using systems, ume.
accessories, etc that consume a great deal
ers. Volvo Washer Solvent should be dilu-
of current when the engine is not running
ted as follows: Down to 14 F (10 C): 1
part washer solvent and 4 parts water
could result in the battery being completely Before a long distance trip
drained. It is always worthwhile to have your vehicle
Down to 5 F (15 C): 1 part washer sol-
vent and 3 parts water Down to 0 F The optional 12 volt socket in the trunk checked at a trained and qualified Volvo serv-
(18 C): 1 part washer solvent and 2 parts (certain models only) provides electrical ice technician before driving long distances.
water Down to 18 F (28 C): 1 part current even with the ignition switched off, Your trained and qualified Volvo service tech-
washer solvent and 1 part water. which drains the battery. nician will also be able to supply you with
06 bulbs, fuses, spark plugs and wiper blades for
Use Volvo Teflon Lock Spray in the locks.
your use in the event that problems occur.
NOTE As a minimum, the following items should be
checked before any long trip:
Avoid using de-icing sprays as they can
cause damage to the locks. Check that engine runs smoothly and that
fuel consumption is normal.
Check for fuel, oil, and fluid leakage
Have the transmission oil level checked2.
Check condition of drive belts.

2 To prevent injury from contact with hot surfaces, do not inspect your vehicle's transmission fluid yourself. Have your vehicle's transmission fluid level inspected by a qualified Volvo service technician.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

138
06 Starting and driving

General information

Check state of the battery's charge.


Examine tires carefully (the spare tire as
well), and replace those that are worn.
Check tire pressures.
The brakes, front wheel alignment, and
steering gear should be checked by your
Volvo retailer only.
Check all lights, including high beams.
Reflective warning triangles are legally
required in some states/provinces.
Have a word with your Volvo retailer if you
intend to drive in countries where it may be
difficult to obtain the correct fuel.
Consider your destination. If you will be
driving through an area where snow or ice
are likely to occur, consider snow tires.

06

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

139
06 Starting and driving

Fuel requirements

Octane rating engine's capacity, and for the smoothest pos- Use of Additives
sible operation. With the exception of gas line antifreeze during
Minimum octane winter months, do not add solvents, thicken-
NOTE ers, or other store-bought additives to your
vehicle's fuel, cooling, or lubricating systems.
When switching to higher octane fuel or
changing gasoline brands, it may be neces- Overuse may damage your engine, and some
sary to fill the tank more than once before a of these additives contain organically volatile
difference in engine operation is noticeable. chemicals. Do not needlessly expose yourself
to these chemicals.
Fuel Formulations
Do not use gasoline that contains lead as a WARNING
G028920
knock inhibitor, and do not use lead additives. Never carry a cell phone that is switched
Besides damaging the exhaust emission con- on while refueling your vehicle. If the phone
trol systems on your vehicle, lead has been rings, this may cause a spark that could
strongly linked to certain forms of cancer. ignite gasoline fumes, resulting in fire and
Typical pump octane label injury.
Volvo recommends premium fuel for best per- Many fuels contain benzene as a solvent.
formance, but using 87 octane or above will not Unburned benzene has been strongly linked to
affect engine reliability. certain forms of cancer. If you live in an area WARNING
06 where you must fill your own gas tank, take Carbon monoxide is a poisonous, colorless,
Volvo engines are designed to achieve rated precautions. These may include: and odorless gas. It is present in all exhaust
horsepower, torque, and fuel economy per- gases. If you ever smell exhaust fumes
formance using premium 91 octane fuel. standing upwind away from the filler nozzle inside the vehicle, make sure the passenger
while refueling compartment is ventilated, and immediately
Demanding driving refueling only at gas stations with vapor return the vehicle to a trained and qualified
In demanding driving conditions, such as oper- recovery systems that fully seal the mouth Volvo service technician for correction.
ating the vehicle in hot weather, towing a trailer, of the filler neck during refueling
or driving for extended periods at higher alti-
tudes than normal, it may be advisable to
wearing neoprene gloves while handling a
fuel filler nozzle.
switch to higher octane fuel (91 or higher) or to
change gasoline brands to fully utilize your

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

140
06 Starting and driving

Fuel requirements

Deposit control gasoline (detergent tiveness of the emission control system and use of the following "oxygenated" fuels; how-
additives) could result in loss of emission warranty cov- ever, the octane ratings listed on this page
Volvo recommends the use of detergent gas- erage. State and local vehicle inspection pro- must still be met. Alcohol Ethanol: Fuels
oline to control engine deposits. Detergent grams will make detection of misfueling easier, containing up to 10% ethanol by volume may
gasoline is effective in keeping injectors and possibly resulting in emission test failure for be used. Ethanol may also be referred to as
intake valves clean. Consistent use of deposit misfueled vehicles. Ethyl alcohol, or "Gasohol". Ethers MTBE:
control gasolines will help ensure good driva- Fuels containing up to 15% MTBE may be
bility and fuel economy. If you are not sure NOTE used.
whether the gasoline contains deposit control Some U.S. and Canadian gasolines contain
additives, check with the service station oper- an octane enhancing additive called methyl- Fuel filler door
ator. cyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl Press the button on the light switch panel (see
(MMT). If such fuels are used, your Emission the illustration on page 63) with the ignition
NOTE Control System performance may be affec-
ted, and the Check Engine Light (malfunc- switched off to unlock the fuel filler door.
Volvo does not recommend the use of tion indicator lamp) located on your instru- Please note that the fuel filler door will remain
store-bought fuel injector cleaning addi- ment panel may light. If this occurs, please unlocked until the vehicle begins to move for-
tives. return your vehicle to a trained and qualified ward. An audible click will be heard when the
Volvo service technician for maintenance. fuel filler door relocks.
If you intend to leave your vehicle while it is
Unleaded fuel
Gasoline containing alcohol and ethers being refueled, this feature enables you to lock 06
Each Volvo has a three-way catalytic converter the doors/trunk while leaving the fuel filler door
and must use only unleaded gasoline. U.S. and Some fuel suppliers sell gasoline containing
unlocked.
Canadian regulations require that pumps deliv- "oxygenates" which are usually alcohols or
ering unleaded gasoline be labelled "UNLEA- ethers. In some areas, state or local laws You can also keep the vehicle locked if you
DED". Only these pumps have nozzles which require that the service pump be marked indi- remain inside it during refueling. The central
fit your vehicle's filler inlet. It is unlawful to dis- cating use of alcohols or ethers. However, locking button does not lock the fuel filler door.
pense leaded fuel into a vehicle labelled there are areas in which the pumps are Be sure the fuel filler door is not obstructed and
"unleaded gasoline only". Leaded gasoline unmarked. If you are not sure whether there is is completely closed after refueling. Open the
damages the three-way catalytic converter and alcohol or ethers in the gasoline you buy, check fuel filler cap slowly during hot weather.
the heated oxygen sensor system. Repeated with the service station operator. To meet sea-
use of leaded gasoline will lessen the effec- sonal air quality standards, some areas require
the use of "oxygenated" fuel. Volvo allows the

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

141
06 Starting and driving

Fuel requirements

Refueling CAUTION under the New Vehicle Limited War-


The fuel tank is designed to accommodate ranty.
possible expansion of the fuel in hot weather,
Do not refuel with the engine running1.
Turn the ignition off or to position I. If the
see page 267 for fuel tank volume. Be aware
ignition is on, an incorrect reading could
that the "usable" tank capacity will be some-
occur in the fuel gauge
what less than the specified maximum. When
the fuel level is low, such factors as ambient After refueling, close the fuel filler cap
temperature, the fuel's "Reid vapor pressure" by turning it clockwise until it clicks into
characteristics, and terrain can affect the fuel place.
pump's ability to supply the engine with an Avoid overfilling the fuel tank. Do not
adequate supply of fuel. Therefore, it is advis- press the handle on the filler nozzle
able to refuel as soon as possible when the more than one extra time. Too much
needle nears the red zone, or when the fuel fuel in the tank in hot weather conditions
warning light comes on. can cause the fuel to overflow. Overfill-
ing could also cause damage to the
emission control systems.
Avoid spilling gasoline during refueling.
In addition to causing damage to the
environment, gasolines containing
alcohol can cause damage to painted
06
surfaces, which may not be covered
under the New Vehicle Limited War-
ranty.
Do not use gasolines containing meth-
anol (methyl alcohol, wood alcohol).
This practice can result in vehicle per-
formance deterioration and can dam-
age critical parts in the fuel system.
Such damage may not be covered

1 If the fuel filler cap is not closed tightly or if the engine is running when the vehicle is refueled, the Check Engine Light (malfunction indicator lamp) may indicate a fault. However, your vehicles
performance will not be affected. Use only Volvo original or approved fuel filler caps.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

142
06 Starting and driving

Ignition switch

Ignition switch positions II Drive position


The key's position when driv-
0 Locked position ing. The vehicle's entire elec-
Remove the key to lock the trical system is activated.
steering wheel1. Never turn
the key to position 0 while
driving or when the vehicle is
being towed.
III Start position
Turn the key to this position
NOTE and release it immediately.
The key returns automatically
A ticking sound may be audible if the key is
to the Drive position.
turned to a position between 0 and I. To
stop this sound, turn the key to position II A chime will sound if the key
and back to position 0. is left in the ignition and the
driver's door is opened (does not apply to vehi-
I Intermediate position2 cles with the optional keyless drive).
Certain accessories, radio,
etc. on, daytime running lights
off. 06

1 Automatic transmission: the gear selector must be in the Park position. The optional keyless drive start control does not need to be removed.
2 Please be aware that leaving the key in this positions I or II will increase battery drain.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

143
06 Starting and driving

Starting the vehicle

To start the engine pedal, turn the key to position III and NOTE
release it. The starter motor will then oper-
WARNING Immobilizer: If two of the keys to your
ate automatically (for up to ten seconds)
Before starting, check that the seat, steering until the engine starts. If the engine fails to vehicle are close together, e.g., on the
wheel and mirrors are adjusted properly. start, repeat this step. same key ring when you try to start the
Make sure the brake pedal can be vehicle, this could cause interference in
depressed completely. Adjust the seat if 4. To release the gear selector from the Park the immobilizer system and result in the
necessary. (P) position, the engine must be running (or vehicle not starting. If this should occur,
the ignition key must be in position II) and remove one of the keys from the key
1. Fasten the seat belt. the brake pedal must be depressed. ring before trying to start the vehicle
again.
2. Apply the parking brake if not already set. 5. Select the desired gear. On models with an
The gear selector should be locked in the automatic transmission, the gear engages Keylock: Models equipped an auto-
after a very slight delay which is especially matic transmission have a keylock sys-
Park (P) position (Shiftlock). See also page tem. When the engine is switched off,
151. noticeable when selecting R.
the gear selector must be in the Park
Manual transmission: The clutch must be (P) position before the key can be
fully depressed. removed from the ignition switch1.
When starting in cold weather, the
NOTE transmission may shift up at slightly
higher engine speeds than normal until
06 After a cold start, idle speed may be notice- the automatic transmission fluid rea-
ably higher than normal for a short period.
ches normal operating temperature.
This is done to help bring components in the
emission control system to their normal Do not race a cold engine immediately
operating temperature as quickly as possi- after starting. Oil flow may not reach
ble, which enables them to control emis- some lubrication points fast enough to
sions and help reduce the vehicle's impact prevent engine damage.
on the environment.

3. The vehicle is equipped with an autostart


feature. Without touching the throttle

1 The optional keyless drive start control does not need to be removed from the ignition switch.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

144
06 Starting and driving

Starting the vehicle

WARNING
Volvo's floor mats are specially manufac-
tured for your car. They must be firmly
secured in the clips on the floor so that they
cannot slide and become trapped under the
pedals on the driver's side.
Always place the gear selector in Park
(P) (manual transmission: first or reverse
gear) and apply the parking brake
before leaving the vehicle.and apply the
parking brake before leaving the vehi-
cle. Never leave the vehicle unattended
with the engine running.
Always open garage doors fully before
starting the engine inside a garage to
ensure adequate ventilation. The
exhaust gases contain carbon monox-
ide, which is invisible and odorless but
very poisonous.
06

CAUTION
Automatic transmission: The engine
should be idling when you move the gear
selector. Never accelerate until after you
feel the transmission engage! Accelerating
immediately after selecting a gear will cause
harsh engagement and premature trans-
mission wear. Selecting P or N when idling
at a standstill for prolonged periods of time
will help prevent overheating of the auto-
matic transmission fluid.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

145
06 Starting and driving

Starting the vehicle with keyless drive (option as available)

Starting a vehicle with keyless drive NOTE


A keyless drive remote control must be
inside the vehicle in order to start the
engine.

1. Press the brake pedal (the clutch pedal


must also be fully depressed on models
with a manual transmission).
2. Press in the keyless drive start control and
turn it to position III.

G019420
G019410
NOTE
The vehicle is equipped with an autostart
function that makes it possible to start the Removing the keyless drive start control
engine without holding the start control in 1. Press the catch on the side of the start
Starting a vehicle with keyless drive position III. Turn the start control to position control (see the illustration).
Keyless drive makes it possible to unlock, start III and release it. The starter motor will then
and lock the vehicle without using a remote operate automatically (for up to ten sec- 2. Pull the keyless drive start control out of
06 onds) until the engine starts. the ignition switch.
control.
A start control is fitted in the ignition switch on 3. Insert the remote control into the ignition
Starting the vehicle with the ignition key switch and turn it to position III to start the
vehicles equipped with the optional keyless
(remote control) engine. See also page 144 for complete
drive. This control is used in the same way as
A vehicle with keyless drive can also be started starting information.
the ignition key to start the engine. See also
with the ignition key (if, for example, the battery
page 144 for general information on starting
in the keyless drive remote control is weak). To
the engine.
do so:

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

146
06 Starting and driving

Manual transmission, 5-speed (certain markets only)

5-speed manual transmission (option Engaging reverse gear, 5-speed CAUTION


on certain models) transmission
Never shift into reverse while moving for-
ward.

WARNING
An extra mat on the driver's floor can cause
the accelerator, brake, and/or clutch pedal
to catch. Check that the movement of these
pedals is not impeded. Not more than one
protective floor covering may be used at
one time.
G018256

G018257
Depress the clutch pedal completely when Reverse gear should only be engaged from a
changing gears1. complete stop.
Remove your foot from the clutch pedal while 06
driving. The shift pattern should be followed. NOTE
Overdrive (5th gear) should be used as often as Reverse gear is electronically blocked to
help prevent it from being selected while the
possible to help improve fuel economy.
vehicle is moving foward.

1 Clutch interlock: The clutch must be fully depressed before you can start your car. If the clutch is not depressed, it will not be possible to start the engine.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

147
06 Starting and driving

Manual transmission, 6-speed (certain markets only)

6-speed manual transmission (option Engaging reverse gear, 6-speed CAUTION


on certain models) transmission
Never shift into reverse while moving for-
ward.

WARNING
An extra mat on the driver's floor can cause
the accelerator, brake, and/or clutch pedal
to catch. Check that the movement of these
pedals is not impeded. Not more than one
protective floor covering may be used at
one time.
G018258

G018259
Depress the clutch pedal completely when Reverse gear should only be engaged from a
changing gears1. complete stop.
06 Remove your foot from the clutch pedal while
driving. The shift pattern should be followed. NOTE
Overdrive (5th and 6th gears) should be used Reverse gear is electronically blocked to
help prevent it from being selected while the
as often as possible to help improve fuel econ-
vehicle is moving foward.
omy.

1 Clutch interlock: The clutch must be fully depressed before you can start your car. If the clutch is notdepressed, it will not be possible to start the engine.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

148
06 Starting and driving

Automatic transmission (option)

Shiftgate positions Gear selector positions R Reverse


The car must be stationary when shifting to
P Park position R.
Select the P position when starting or parking.
In P, the transmission is mechanically blocked
N Neutral
(Shiftlock). Always apply the parking brake N is the neutral position. The engine can be
when parking. started, but no gear is selected. Apply the park-
ing brake when the car is stationary with the
gear selector in N.

NOTE
If the gear selector is in the Neutral position
G020237
and the vehicle has been at a standstill for
at least 3 seconds, the brake pedal must be
pressed before the gear selector can be
moved to another position.
Depress the button on the front of the gear
selector knob to move the selector between In order to move the gear selector to another
the R, N, D, and P positions. position:

G018264
The gear selector can be moved freely between 1. Turn the ignition key to position II (if the 06
the Geartronic (manual shifting) and Drive (D) engine is not already running).
positions while driving.
D - left position: automatic shifting, M - right posi- 2. Depress the brake pedal.
tion: manual shifting
3. Move the gear selector to the desired posi-
CAUTION tion.

The car must be stationary when selecting D Drive


position P. D is the normal driving position. The Drive posi-
tion offers 5 forward gears1. The car automat-
ically shifts between the various forward gears,

1 T5 models have 6 forward gears.


``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

149
06 Starting and driving

Automatic transmission (option)

based on the level of acceleration and speed. the engine. If the current speed is too high Kickdown will not occur if the driver attempts
The car must be at a standstill when shifting to for using a lower gear, the downshift will to use this function when engine speeds are
position D from position R. not occur until the speed has decreased too high. The transmission will remain in the
enough to allow the lower gear to be used. currently selected gear.
Manual shifting Geartronic If you slow to a very low speed, the trans-
mission will automatically shift down.
The manual shifting mode (Geartronic) can be
selected at any time to manually select forward
gears, including while the car is moving. Cold starts (turbo engines)
When driving before the engine has reached its
NOTE normal operating temperature, the transmis-
sion will shift up at slightly higher engine
Reverse, Neutral, and Park cannot be
speeds to heat the three-way catalytic con-
selected in Geartronic mode.
verter as quickly as possible.

To access the Manual (M) shifting position


from Drive (D), move the gear selector to Kickdown
the right to M. Automatic shift to a lower gear (kickdown) is
To return to the Drive (D) position from M, achieved by depressing the accelerator pedal
move the gear selector to the left. fully and briskly. An upshift will occur when
06 approaching the top speed for a particular gear
While driving or by releasing the accelerator pedal slightly.
If you select the M position while driving, Kickdown can be used for maximum acceler-
the gear that was being used in the Drive ation or when passing at highway speeds.
position will also initially be selected in the
M position. Safety function
To help prevent excessive engine speeds (rpm)
Move the gear selector forward (toward
that could lead to engine damage, the engine
"+") to shift to a higher gear or rearward
(toward "") to shift to a lower gear. management system includes a function that
prevents kickdown from taking place if the
If you hold the gear selector toward "", the engine speed is too high.
transmission will downshift one gear at a
time and will utilize the braking power of

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

150
06 Starting and driving

Shiftlock override

Overriding the shiftlock system 4. Insert the key blade, see page 120, into the
opening and press it down until it bottoms.
5. With the key blade pressed down, move
the gear selector out of the P position.

G018263

Shiftlock prevents the gear selector from being


moved out of Park unless the ignition key is in
position II and the brake pedal is depressed.
In certain cases it may be necessary to move 06
the gear selector from the Park position man-
ually.

To manually override the Shiftlock


system:
1. Apply the parking brake.
2. Depress the brake pedal.
3. There is a small cover below P-R-N-D on
the gear selector panel. Open the rear edge
of the panel.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

151
06 Starting and driving

All Wheel Drive (option)

All Wheel Drive (AWD) general Temporary Spare


information The temporary spare tire is for temporary, low-
Your Volvo can be equipped with permanent speed, short-distance use only. Replace it with
All Wheel Drive (option), which means that a full-sized tire as soon as possible. Do not
power is distributed automatically between the drive on the temporary spare at speeds above
front and rear wheels. Under normal driving 50 mph (80 km/h).
conditions, most of the engine's power is Never install snow chains on a temporary
directed to the front wheels. However, if there spare.
is any tendency for the front wheels to spin, an
electronically controlled coupling distributes
power to the wheels that have the best traction.

Tire dimensions
Volvo recommends that you always drive on
tires of the same brand, size, construction
(radial), tread pattern, load, speed, traction,
temperature, and treadwear rating. Never drive
on mixed tires, except for brief periods when
the temporary spare tire is in use.
06
Always use properly inflated tires of correct
dimensions. Tire size and inflation pressures
are shown on a placard located on the driver's
side B-pillar (the structural member at the side
of the vehicle, at the rear of the driver's door
opening). See also page 178 for the tire infla-
tion pressure tables beginning, .

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

152
06 Starting and driving

Brake system

Brake circuit malfunction Power brakes function only when the Severe strain on the brake system
The brake system is a hydraulic system con- engine is running The brakes will be subject to severe strain
sisting of two separate brake circuits. If a prob- The power brakes utilize vacuum pressure when driving in mountains or hilly areas, or
lem should occur in one of these circuits, it is which is only created when the engine is run- when towing a trailer. Vehicle speed is usually
still possible to stop the vehicle with the other ning. Never let the vehicle roll to a stop with the slower, which means that the cooling of the
brake circuit. engine switched off. brakes is less efficient than when driving on
level roads. To reduce the strain on the brakes,
If the brake pedal must be depressed farther If the power brakes are not working, the brake
shift into a lower gear and let the engine help
than normal and requires greater foot pressure, pedal must be pressed approximately five
with the braking. Do not forget that if you are
the stopping distance will be longer. times harder than usual to make up for the lack
towing a trailer, the brakes will be subjected to
A warning light in the instrument panel will light of power assistance. This can happen for
a greater than normal load.
up to warn the driver that a fault has occurred. example when towing your vehicle or if the
engine is switched off when the vehicle is roll-
If this light comes on while driving or braking, ing. The brake pedal feels harder than usual. Anti-lock brakes (ABS)
stop immediately and check the brake fluid The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) helps to
level in the reservoir. improve vehicle control (stopping and steering)
Water on brake discs and brake pads
affects braking during severe braking conditions by limiting
NOTE brake lockup. When the system "senses"
Driving in rain and slush or passing through an
Press the brake pedal hard and maintain impending lockup, braking pressure is auto-
automatic car wash can cause water to collect
pressure on the pedal do not pump the matically modulated in order to help prevent
on the brake discs and pads. This will cause a 06
brakes. lockup that could lead to a skid.
delay in braking effect when the pedal is
depressed. To avoid such a delay when the The system performs a self-diagnostic test
WARNING brakes are needed, depress the pedal occa- when the engine is started and when the
sionally when driving through rain, slush, etc. vehicle first reaches a speed of approxi-
If the fluid level is below the MIN mark in the This will remove the water from the brakes. mately 12 mph (20 km/h). The brake pedal will
reservoir or if a brake system message is
Check that brake application feels normal. This pulsate several times and a sound may be
shown in the information display, DO NOT
DRIVE. Have the vehicle towed to a Volvo should also be done after washing or starting audible from the ABS control module. This is
retailer and have the brake system inspec- in very damp or cold weather. normal.
ted.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

153
06 Starting and driving

Brake system

For optimal ABS braking effect: WARNING NOTE


1. Press down on the brake pedal with full
force. The pedal will pulsate. If the BRAKES and ABS warning symbols When the EBA system is activated, the
light at the same time, there may be a prob- brake pedal will go down and pressure
2. Steer the vehicle in the direction of travel lem in the brake system. If the brake fluid in the brake system immediately increa-
and keep the brake pedal depressed. level is normal in these circumstances, drive ses to the maximum level. You must
carefully to a trained and qualified Volvo maintain full pressure on the brake
Electronic Brake Force Distribution service technician to have the brake system pedal in order to utilize the system com-
(EBD) checked.
pletely. There will be no braking effect if
EBD is an integrated part of the ABS system. the pedal is released. EBA is automati-
EBD regulates the hydraulic pressure to the Emergency Brake Assistance EBA cally deactivated when the brake pedal
rear brakes to help provide optimal braking EBA is designed to provide full brake effect is released.
capacity. immediately in the event of sudden, hard brak- When the vehicle has been parked for
The switching of the ABS modulator will be ing. The system is activated by the speed with some time, the brake pedal may sink
audible and the brake pedal will pulsate during which the brake pedal is depressed. more than usual when the engine is
braking. Please be aware that ABS does not When the EBA system is activated, the brake started. This is normal and the pedal will
increase the absolute braking potential of the return to its usual position when it is
pedal will go down and pressure in the brake
released.
vehicle. While control will be enhanced, ABS system immediately increases to the maximum
will not shorten stopping distances on slippery level. Maintain full pressure on the brake pedal
surfaces. in order to utilize the system completely. EBA
06
If the warning lamp lights up there is a mal- is automatically deactivated when the brake
function of the ABS system (the standard brak- pedal is released.
ing system will still function) and the vehicle
should be driven cautiously to a trained and
qualified Volvo service technicianfor inspec-
tion.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

154
06 Starting and driving

Stability system

Stability Traction Control (STC)/ Temporarily switching off Spin control


Dynamic Stability Traction Control 1. Turn the thumbwheel (A) on the left-side
(DSTC) steering wheel lever until the STC/DSTC
The stability system consists of a number of menu is displayed.
functions designed help reduce wheel spin, 2. Hold down the RESET button (B) to toggle
counteract skidding, and to generally help between STC/DSTC SPIN CONTROL
improve directional stability. ON or OFF.
A pulsating sound will be audible when the
system is actively operating and is normal. NOTE
The message STC/DSTC SPIN
Function/ STC DSTCA CONTROL OFF indicates that the sta-

G020349
system bility system's spin control function has
temporarily been switched off.
TC X X
A - thumb wheel, B - RESET button The stability control indicator light
SC X X will illuminate and remain on until spin
Spin control (SC)
control has been reactivated.
AYC X The spin control function is designed to help
prevent the drive wheels from spinning while The spin control function is automati-
A Option on certain models. cally enabled each time the engine is
the vehicle is accelerating. 06
started.
Traction control TC Under certain circumstances, such as when
driving with snow chains, or driving in deep
STC/DSTC ON indicates that all sys-
This function is designed to help reduce wheel tem functions are active.
spin by transferring power from a drive wheel snow or loose sand, it may be advisable to
that begins to lose traction to the wheel on the temporarily switch off this function for maxi-
opposite side of the vehicle (on the same axle). mum tractive force1. Active yaw control AYC (DSTC only)
This function helps maintain directional stabil-
TC is most active at low speeds. ity, for example when cornering, by braking
This is one of the stability system's permanent one or more of the wheels if the vehicle shows
functions and cannot be switched off. a tendency to skid or slide laterally.

1 Models equipped with All Wheel Drive (AWD) have an integrated traction control function that cannot be disabled. DSTC is optional on AWD models.
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

155
06 Starting and driving

Stability system

This is one of the stability system's permanent Information symbol WARNING


functions and cannot be switched off.
The stability system is intended to help
improve driving safety. It supplements, but
WARNING can never replace, the driver's judgement
The car's handling and stability characteris- and responsibility when operating the vehi-
If the and symbols light up at the same cle. Speed and driving style should always
tics will be altered if the STC/DSTC system
functions have been disabled. time, read the message in the display. be adapted to traffic and road conditions.
If only the symbol lights up, this indicates
STC/DSTC-related messages in the text one of the following situations:
window The light illuminates for approximately
"TRACTION CONTROL TEMPORARILY 2 seconds to indicate that the system is
OFF" The system has been temporarily performing a self-diagnostic test when the
switched off due to high brake temperature engine is started.
and will automatically switch on again
when the brakes have cooled.
If the light flashes while driving, this indi-
cates that the stability system is actively
"ANTI SKID SERVICE REQUIRED" the functioning to help counteract wheel spin
system has been automatically disen- and/or a skid.
gaged due to a fault. A trained and qualified
Volvo service technician should check the
If this light stays on after the engine has
06 started or comes on while driving, there
system. may be a fault in the stability system. Con-
sult a trained and qualified Volvo service
Symbols used by the stability system technician.

Stability system indicator light If Spin control has been intentionally


switched off, a message is displayed and
the light will stay on as a reminder that this
function has been disabled by the driver.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

156
06 Starting and driving

Towing

Emergency towing WARNING 4. Place the gear selector in neutral. For vehi-
cles with automatic transmissions, follow
Do not use the towing eyelets to pull the instruction on page 151, "Shiftlock over-
vehicle up onto a flat bed tow truck. ride" to allow the gear selector to be moved
from the Park position.
Towing a vehicle with all four wheels on 5. Keep firm pressure on the brake pedal
the ground while releasing the parking brake.
6. When towing has been completed, return
WARNING the gear selector to Park (automatic) or
Volvo does not recommend towing a disa- Reverse (manual) and apply the parking
bled vehicle behind another vehicle. Signif- brake.
icant difficulty in steering and braking,
combined with unfavorable weather, traffic, The following points should also be
G030710

and road conditions may make it impossible observed:


to maintain vehicle control. Never exceed 50 mph (80 km/h). Never
exceed local towing speed limits and heed
The towing eyelet is located under the floor of all local towing restrictions.
the trunk. This eyelet must be screwed into the 1. Apply the parking brake.
positions provided on the right sides of either Never tow farther than 50 miles (80 km).
the front or rear bumper (see the illustration). WARNING Keep the tow rope taut at all times while the 06
Towing a vehicle with a locked steering vehicle is in motion.
To attach the towing eyelet: wheel will make the vehicle impossible to
1. Press the mark on the lower edge of the
The disabled vehicle should be towed in
steer. the forward direction only.
cover (1) to open it.
2. Screw the towing eyelet in place first by 2. Insert the key into the ignition to unlock the
hand and then using the tire iron until it is steering wheel. The steering wheel must be
securely in place. unlocked. With the engine off and the vehi-
After the vehicle has been towed, the eyelet cle at a standstill, great effort will be
should be removed and returned to its storage required to turn the steering wheel.
space. Press the cover back into position. 3. Turn the ignition key to position II.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

157
06 Starting and driving

Towing

WARNING Towing vehicles with front wheel drive WARNING


Volvo recommends the use of flat bed equip-
Never allow a vehicle to be towed with-
ment for towing vehicles with front wheel drive.
Remember that the power brakes and
out a driver behind the wheel of the power steering will not function when
disabled vehicle.
If wheel lift equipment must be used, please engine is not running. The braking and
use extreme caution to help avoid damage to steering systems will function but the
Never remove the key from the ignition the vehicle.
while the vehicle is moving. The steering brake pedal pressure required is
wheel could lock, making it impossible In this case, the vehicle should be towed with 3 5 times above normal and greater
to steer the vehicle. the rear wheels on the ground if at all possible. steering effort must be exerted.

When the engine is not running, steering If it is absolutely necessary to tow the vehicle The towing eyelets must not be used for
resistance and the effort needed to with the front wheels on the ground, please pulling the vehicle out of a ditch or for
apply the brakes will be great. any similar purpose involving severe
refer to the towing information on the previous
strain. Do not use the towing eyelets to
Never attempt to tow a vehicle with a page.
pull the vehicle up onto a flat bed tow
dead battery at night.
Sling-type equipment applied at the front truck.
will damage radiator and air conditioning
CAUTION lines.
It is equally important not to use sling-type
Check with state and local authorities equipment at the rear or apply lifting equip-
before attempting this type of towing, ment inside the rear wheels; serious dam-
06 as vehicles being towed are subject to age to the rear axle may result.
regulations regarding maximum towing
speed, length and type of towing If the vehicle is being towed on a flat bed
device, lighting, marker flags, etc. truck, the towing eyelets must not be used
to secure the vehicle on the flat bed. Con-
Never attempt to push- or tow-start a sult the tow truck operator.
vehicle with a dead battery. This would
inject unburned fuel into the three-way
catalytic converter(s), causing over-
heating, backfiring, and damage, see
page 159 for instructions on jump star-
ting the vehicle.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

158
06 Starting and driving

Jump starting

3. Connect the auxiliary battery's negative () WARNING


terminal (3) to the ground point in your
vehicle's engine compartment near the Do not connect the jumper cable to any part
driver's side spring strut (4). of the fuel system or to any moving parts.
Avoid touching hot manifolds.
4. Start the engine in the assisting vehicle,
then start the engine in the vehicle with
Batteries generate hydrogen gas, which
is flammable and explosive.
dead battery.
Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do
5. After the engine has started, first remove not allow battery fluid to contact eyes,
the negative () terminal jumper cable. skin, fabrics or painted surfaces. If con-
Then remove the positive (+) terminal tact occurs, flush the affected area
jumper cable. immediately with water. Obtain medical
G020298 help immediately if eyes are affected.
WARNING Never expose the battery to open flame
PROPOSITION 65 WARNING! or electric spark.
Follow these instructions to jump start your
Battery posts, terminals, and related acces- Do not smoke near the battery.
vehicle's dead battery or to jump start another
vehicle's dead battery using your vehicle. If the sories contain lead and lead compounds, Failure to follow the instructions for
chemicals known to the state of California jump starting can lead to personal
12-volt auxiliary battery to be used is in another
to cause cancer and reproductive harm. injury.
vehicle, check that the vehicles are not touch- Wash hands after handling. 06
ing to prevent premature completion of a cir- Do not touch the jumper cables during
cuit. Be sure to follow jump starting instruc- the attempt to start the vehicle. This
tions provided for the other vehicle. could cause sparks.

To jump start your vehicle:


1. Switch off the ignition.
2. First connect the auxiliary battery positive
(+) terminal (1) to the positive (+) terminal in
your vehicle's battery (2), marked with a
"+" sign.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

159
06 Starting and driving

Towing a trailer

General information Trailer towing does not normally present any More frequent vehicle maintenance is
Volvo recommends the use of Volvo trailer particular problems, but take into considera- required.
hitches that are specially designed for the tion: Remove the ball and drawbar assembly
vehicle. Increase tire pressure to recommended when the hitch is not being used.
full. See the chapter "Wheels and tires." Volvo recommends the use of synthetic
CAUTION When your vehicle is new, avoid towing engine oil when towing a trailer over long
Models equipped with the B5244S7 engine heavy trailers during the first 620 miles distances or in mountainous areas.
(engine code 39 , which is the 6th and (1,000 km).
7th digits from the left in your vehicle's VIN
Maximum speed when towing a trailer: WARNING
number, see page 262 for the location of
50 mph (80 km/h). Bumper-attached trailer hitches must
the VIN plate), may not be used to tow trail-
ers or vehicles of any kind. This could cause Engine and transmission are subject to not be used on Volvos, nor should
damage to the vehicle's emission control increased loads. Therefore, engine coolant safety chains be attached to the
systems. temperature should be closely watched bumper.
when driving in hot climates or hilly terrain. Trailer hitches attaching to the vehicle's
Maximum trailer weights recommended by Use a lower gear and turn off the air con- rear axle must not be used.
Volvo are: ditioner if the temperature gauge needle
enters the red range. Never connect a trailer's hydraulic
brake system directly to the vehicle
Trailers without brakes: 1,540 lbs
If the automatic transmission begins to brake system, nor a trailer's lighting
(700 kg). overheat, a message will be displayed in
06 system directly to the vehicle lighting
Trailers with brakes: 2,000 lbs (900 kg) the information display. system. Consult your nearest trained
Observe the legal requirements of the and qualified Volvo service technician
state/province in which the vehicles are
Avoid overload and other abusive opera-
tion. for correct installation.
registered.
Hauling a trailer affects handling, durabil- When towing a trailer, the trailer's safety
The maximum recommended hitch ity, and economy. wire must be correctly fastened to the
tongue load is 165 lbs (75 kg). hole or hook provided in the trailer hitch
It is necessary to balance trailer brakes
All Volvo models are equipped with with the towing vehicle brakes to provide a
on the vehicle. The safety wire should
energy-absorbing shock-mounted bump- never be fastened to or wound around
safe stop (check and observe state/local
ers. Trailer hitch installation should not the drawbar ball.
regulations).
interfere with the proper operation of this
bumper system. Do not connect the trailer's brake system
directly to the vehicle's brake system.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

160
06 Starting and driving

Towing a trailer

NOTE
When parking the vehicle with a trailer
on a hill, apply the parking brake before
putting the gear selector in Park (P) or
in reverse on models with a manual
transmission. Always follow the trailer
manufacturer's recommendations for
wheel chocking.
If you use the manual (Geartronic) shift
positions while towing a trailer, or if the
vehicle is equipped with a manual trans-
mission, make sure the gear you select
does not put too much strain on the
engine (using too high a gear).
The drawbar assembly/trailer hitch may
be rated for trailers heavier than the
vehicle is designed to tow. Please
adhere to Volvo's recommended trailer
weights.
06
Avoid driving with a trailer on inclines
exceeding 15%.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

161
06 Starting and driving

Detachable trailer hitch

Installing the ball holder 5. Insert the cotter pin in the hole at the end
of the locking bolt.

Removing the ball holder


1. Remove the cotter pin from the locking bolt
and slide the locking bolt out of the ball
C holder/hitch assembly.
2. Pull the ball holder out of the hitch assem-
bly.
D
E
B
G010496
A
NOTE
A cover for the hitch assembly is also
Ball holder included in the kit.

Locking bolt
Cotter pin
Hitch assembly
06
Safety wire attachment
1. If necessary, remove the cotter pin from
the locking bolt and slide the locking bolt
out of the hitch assembly.
2. Slide the ball holder into the hitch assem-
bly.
3. Align the hole in the ball holder with the one
in the hitch assembly.
4. Slide the locking bolt through the hitch
assembly/ball holder.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

162
06 Starting and driving

Transporting loads

Loading the vehicle WARNING Never exceed the rack manufacturer's


Your vehicle's load-carrying capacity is affec- weigh limits and never exceed the maxi-
ted by factors such as:
Remember that an object weighing mum rated roof load of 165 lbs (75 kg).
44 lbs (20 kg) produces a force of
the number of passengers 2,200 lbs (1,000 kg) in a head-on colli-
Avoid single-point loads. Distribute loads
evenly.
tire inflation sion at 30 mph (50 km/h)!
When the rear backrest(s) are folded
Place heavier cargo at the bottom of the
the amount of optional or accessory equip- load.
ment installed down, the vehicle should not be loaded
to a level higher than 2 in. (5 cm) below Secure the cargo correctly with appropri-
the amount of cargo. the upper edge of the rear side win- ate tie-down equipment.
See the chapter "Wheels and tires" for more dows. Objects placed higher than this Check periodically that the load carriers
detailed information. level could impede the function of the and load are properly secured.
Volvo Inflatable Curtain.
Before loading the car, turn off the engine, and Remember that the car's center of gravity
apply the parking brake when loading or and handling change when you carry a
unloading long objects. The gear selector can load on the roof.
Load carriers (accessory)
be inadvertently knocked out of position by The car's wind resistance and fuel con-
Load carriers are available as Volvo accesso-
long cargo, causing the car to move. sumption will increase with the size of the
ries. Follow the installation instructions sup-
load.
plied with the load carriers.
Keep the following in mind when Drive smoothly. Avoid rapid starts, fast
Observe the following points when using load cornering and hard braking. 06
loading the vehicle:
carriers:
Load objects in the trunk against the rear
seat backrest. To avoid damaging your car and to achieve
maximum safety when driving, we recom-
Load heavy cargo as low as possible.
mend using the load carriers that Volvo has
Center wide loads. developed especially for your car.
Secure all cargo with restraining straps Volvo-approved removable roof racks are
anchored to the load securing eyelets. designed to carry the maximum allowable
Cover sharp edges on the load. roof load for this vehicle: 165 lbs (75 kg).
For Non-Volvo roof racks, check the man-
Seats can be folded down and head
ufacturer's weight limits for the rack.
restraints removed to extend the cargo
compartment, see page 113.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

163
06 Starting and driving

Blind Spot Information System (BLIS)option

Introduction WARNING B
BLIS is an information system, NOT a
warning or safety system.
BLIS does not eliminate the need for A
you to visually confirm the conditions
around you, and the need for you to turn
your head and shoulders to make sure
that you can safely change lanes.
As the driver, you have full responsibility
for changing lanes in a safe manner.

G020296
G020295
The system is based on digital camera tech-
nology. The cameras (1) are located beneath
the side-view mirrors. A = approx. 10 ft. (3 meters), B = approx. 31 ft.
(9.5 meters)
BLIS camera When one (or both) of the cameras have
detected a vehicle in the blind area (up to BLIS has an integrated function that alerts the
Indicator light approximately 10 ft. (3 meters) from the side of driver if a fault should occur with the system.
your vehicle, and up to approximately 31 ft. For example, if one or both of the system's
06 BLIS symbol cameras are obscured, a message (see the
(9.5 meters) behind the side-view mirror), the
The Blind Spot Information System (BLIS) is an indicator light in the door panel (2) illuminates. table on page 167) will appear in the informa-
information system that indicates the presence The light will glow continuously to alert the tion display in the instrument panel. If this
of another vehicle moving in the same direction driver of the vehicle in the blind area. occurs, clean the camera lenses. If necessary,
as your vehicle in the side-view mirror's "blind the system can be temporarily switched off (for
area". NOTE instructions see page 166).

The door panel indicator light illuminates on


CAUTION the side of the vehicle where the system has
The BLIS system should only be repaired by detected another vehicle. If your vehicle is
a trained and qualified Volvo service tech- passed on both sides at the same time, both
nician. lights will illuminate.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

164
06 Starting and driving

Blind Spot Information System (BLIS)option

When does BLIS function Darkness WARNING


The system functions when your vehicle is BLIS reacts to the headlights of surrounding
moving at speeds above 6 mph (10 km/h). vehicles. In order to be detected by BLIS, a BLIS does not react to cyclists or
vehicle in the blind area must have its head- mopeds.
When you pass another vehicle: lights on. This means, for example, that the BLIS does not react to vehicles that are
The system reacts when you pass another system will not detect a trailer without head- standing still.
vehicle at a speed of up to 6 mph (10 km/h) lights that is being towed behind a car or truck. The function of the BLIS cameras may
faster than that vehicle. be affected by intense light, or when
driving at night in areas where there are
When you are passed by another vehicle:
no external sources of light (e.g., street
The system reacts if your vehicle is passed by lights, other vehicles, etc.). In such
another vehicle at a speed of up to 43 mph cases, the system may react as if the
(70 km/h) faster than your vehicle. cameras were obscured.
In both of the above mentioned condi-
WARNING tions, a message will appear in the infor-
mation display.
BLIS does not function in sharp curves.
BLIS does not function when your vehi-
When driving in such conditions, the
system's function will be limited or it
cle is backing up.
may be temporarily switched off, see
If you are towing a wide trailer, this may page 166 for instructions. 06
prevent the BLIS cameras from detect-
ing other vehicles in adjacent lanes.
When the message is no longer dis-
played, BLIS will return to normal func-
tion.
How BLIS functions in daylight and The BLIS cameras have the same limi-
darkness tation as the human eye. In other words,
Daylight their "vision is impaired" by adverse
BLIS reacts to the shape of surrounding vehi- weather conditions such as heavy
snowfall, dense fog, etc.
cles. The system is designed to help detect
motor vehicles such as cars, trucks, buses,
motorcycles, etc.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

165
06 Starting and driving

Blind Spot Information System (BLIS)option

Limitations CAUTION
In certain situations, the BLIS indicator light(s)
may illuminate even when there are no other Clean the lenses carefully to avoid
vehicles in the area monitored by the system. scratching.
The lenses are electrically heated to

G018177
NOTE help melt ice or snow. If necessary, gen-
tly brush away snow from the lenses.
If the BLIS indicator lights illuminate occa-
sionally even when there are no other vehi- The vehicle's own shadow against a large, light,
cles in the blind area, this does not indicate smooth surface such as barriers between lanes on Switching BLIS on and off
a fault in the system. a highway
In the event of a fault, Blind spot syst.
service required will be displayed.

The following are several examples of situa-


tions in which the BLIS indicator light(s) may

G018178
illuminate even when there are no other vehi-
cles in the area monitored by the system.
Sunlight directly in the camera when the sun is low
06 on the horizon

Cleaning the BLIS camera lenses

G018270
In order to function optimally, the BLIS camera
lenses must be kept clean. They can be wiped
G018176

clean with a soft cloth or wet sponge.


BLIS button (left button in the illustration)

Light reflected from a wet road surface BLIS is automatically activated when the igni-
tion is switched on. The indicator lights will
provide confirmation by flashing 3 times.
The system can be switched off by press-
ing the BLIS button in the center console.
The indicator light in the button goes out

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

166
06 Starting and driving

Blind Spot Information System (BLIS)option

when the system is switched off, and a text


message is displayed.
BLIS can be switched on again by pressing
the button. The indicator light in the button
will illuminate and a new text message will
be displayed. Press the READ button, see
page 60, to erase the message.

BLIS system messages


Text in the System status
display
BLIS service BLIS not functioning
required properly. Contact an
authorized Volvo serv-
ice technician.

BLIS camera BLIS camera obscured.


blocked Clean the lenses.

BLIS ON BLIS system on 06

BLIS OFF BLIS system off

BLIS reduced The BLIS cameras'


function function has been
reduced by e.g., fog, or
strong sunlight directly
into the camera. The
camera will reset itself
when these conditions
have changed. have
been function reduced

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

167
06 Starting and driving

Park assist (Option/accessory)

Introduction WARNING NOTE


Park Assist is an information system, NOT a Rear park assist is deactivated automati-
safety system. This system is designed to cally when towing a trailer if Volvo genuine
be a supplementary aid when parking the trailer wiring is used.
vehicle. It is not, however, intended to
replace the driver's attention and judge-
ment. Front park assist
The distance monitored in front of the vehicle
is approximately 2.5 ft (0.8 m). The audible sig-
Function nal comes from the audio system's front
The system is activated automatically when the speakers.
vehicle is started. The indicator light in the but- It may not be possible to combine auxiliary
G020294 ton in the center console illuminates. headlights and front park assist since these
The front park assist system is active from lights could trigger the system's sensors.
the time the engine is started until the vehi-
Front/rear park assist cle exceeds a speed of approximately
10 mph (15 km/h). It is also active when the
The park assist system is designed to assist vehicle is backing up.
you when driving into parking spaces, garages,
etc. It utilizes four ultrasound sensors located Rear park assist is active when the engine
06 is running and reverse gear has been
in one or both bumpers to measure the dis-
selected.
tance to a vehicle, object or a person who may
be close to the front or rear of your vehicle. Rear park assist
Park assist is available in two versions: The distance monitored behind the vehicle is
approximately 5 ft (1.5 m). The signal comes
Rear bumper only
from the rear speakers.
Front and rear bumpers
The system must be deactivated when towing
a trailer, carrying bicycles in a rear-mounted
carrier, etc, which could trigger the rear park
assist system's sensors.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

168
06 Starting and driving

Park assist (Option/accessory)

Activating/deactivating park assist NOTE Faults in the system


If the information symbol illumi-
Front park assist is disengaged auto-
nates and PARK ASSIST
matically when the parking brake is
applied. SERVICE REQUIRED is shown
on the information display, this
If the vehicle is equipped with front and indicates that the system is not
rear park assist, both systems will be functioning properly and has been disengaged.
deactivated by pressing the button.
Consult a Volvo retailer or authorized Volvo
service technician.
Audible signals from the park assist
system CAUTION
The Park Assist system uses an intermittent In certain circumstances, the park assist
system may give unexpected warning sig-
G021267

tone that pulses faster as you come close to an


object, and becomes constant when you are nals that can be caused by external sound
sources that use the same ultrasound fre-
within approximately 1 ft (30 cm) of an object
Park Assist button (lright button in the illustration) quencies as the system. This may include
in front of or behind the vehicle. If the volume such things as the horns of other vehicles,
The system is activated automatically when the of another source from the audio system is wet tires on asphalt, pneumatic brakes,
vehicle is started. high, this will be automatically lowered. motorcycle exhaust pipes, etc. This does
not indicate a fault in the system.
Press the Park assist button on the center If there are objects within this distance both 06
console to temporarily deactivate the sys- behind and in front of the vehicle, the signal
tem(s). The indicator light in the button will alternates between front and rear speakers.
go out when the system has been deacti-
vated.
Park assist will be automatically reactiva-
ted the next time the engine is started, or if
the button is pressed (the indicator light in
the button will illuminate).

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

169
06 Starting and driving

Park assist (Option/accessory)

Cleaning the sensors

G021298

Park assist sensors


The sensors must be cleaned regularly to
ensure that they work properly. Clean them
06
with water and a suitable car washing deter-
gent.
Ice and snow covering the sensors may cause
incorrect warning signals.

NOTE
If the sensors are obstructed by e.g., dirt,
snow, or ice, this could result in false warn-
ing signals from the park assist system.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

170
06 Starting and driving

06

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

171
General information............................................................................... 174
Tire inflation........................................................................................... 176
Inflation pressureU.S. models .......................................................... 178
Inflation pressureCanadian models .................................................. 179
Tire designations................................................................................... 180
Glossary of tire terminology.................................................................. 182
Vehicle loading...................................................................................... 183
Uniform tire quality gradings................................................................. 185
Snow chains, snow tires, studded tires................................................ 186
Temporary spare................................................................................... 187
Wheel nuts............................................................................................ 188
Tire rotation........................................................................................... 189
Changing a wheel................................................................................. 190
Tire Sealing System ............................................................................. 192

G020918
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)............................................. 197

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

172
WHEELS AND TIRES

07
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
07 Wheels and tires

General information

Your vehicle is equipped with tires according optimum road holding on icy or snow-covered WARNING
to the vehicle's tire information placard on the roads, we recommend suitable winter tires on
B-pillar (the structural member at the side of all four wheels. The wheel and tire sizes for your Volvo
the vehicle, at the rear of the driver's door are specified to meet stringent stability
When replacing tires, be sure that the new tires and handling requirements. Unap-
opening), or on the inside of the fuel filler door
are the same size designation, type (radial) and proved wheel/tire size combinations
on Canadian models.
preferably from the same manufacturer, on all can negatively affect your vehicle's sta-
four wheels. Otherwise there is a risk of altering bility and handling. Approved tire sizes
CAUTION the car's roadholding and handling characte- are shown in the Tire inflation pressure
Some Volvo models are equipped with an ristics. tables, see page 178.
Ultra High Performance tire and wheel com- Any damage caused by installation of
bination designed to provide maximum dry Storing wheels and tires
unapproved wheel/tire size combina-
pavement performance with consideration When storing complete wheels (tires mounted
tions will not be covered by your new
for hydroplaning resistance. As such, they on rims), they should be suspended off the vehicle warranty. Volvo assumes no
may be more susceptible to road hazard floor or placed on their sides on the floor.
damage and, depending on driving condi- responsibility for death, injury, or
tions, may achieve a tread life of less than Tires not mounted on rims should be stored on expenses that may result from such
20,000 miles (30,000 km). Even if this vehi- their sides or standing upright, but should not installations.
cle is equipped with Volvos advanced AWD be suspended.
or DSTC system, these tires are not
designed for winter driving, and should be
replaced with winter tires when weather CAUTION
conditions dictate. Tires should preferably be stored in a cool,
dry, dark place, and should never be stored
The tires have good road holding characteris- in close proximity to solvents, gasoline, oils,
etc.
tics and offer good handling on dry and wet
07
surfaces. It should be noted however that the
tires have been developed to give these fea-
tures on snow/ice-free surfaces.
Certain models are equipped with "all-season"
tires, which provide a somewhat higher degree
of road holding on slippery surfaces than tires
without the "all-season" rating. However, for

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

174
07 Wheels and tires

General information

Tread wear indicator New Tires Tire wear increases with speed.
Remember that tires are per- Correct front wheel alignment is very
ishable goods. As of 2000, the important.
manufacturing week and year
Unbalanced wheels impair tire economy
(Department of Transporta- and driving comfort.
tion (DOT) stamp) will be indi-
cated with 4 digits (e.g. 1502 Tires must maintain the same direction of
rotation throughout their lifetime.
means that the tire illustrated
was manufactured during week 15 of 2002). When replacing tires, the tires with the
most tread should be mounted on the rear
Tire age wheels to reduce the chance of oversteer
Tires degrade over time, even when they are during hard braking.
not being used. It is recommended that tires Hitting curbs or potholes can damage the
generally be replaced after 6 years of normal
G020323

tires and/or wheels permanently.


service. Heat caused by hot climates, frequent
high loading conditions or Ultra Violet (U.V)
The tires have wear indicator strips running exposure can accelerate the aging process.
across or parallel to the tread. The letters TWI You should replace the spare tire when you
are printed on the side of the tire. When replace the other road tires due to the aging of
approximately 1/16" (1.6 mm) is left on the the spare.
tread, these strips become visible and indicate
A tire's age can be determined by the DOT
that the tire should be replaced. Tires with less
stamp on the sidewall (see the illustration).
than 1/16" (1.6 mm) tread offer very poor trac-
tion. A tire with e.g., visible cracks or discoloration
should be replaced immediately. 07
When replacing worn tires, it is recommended
that the tire be identical in type (radial) and size Improving tire economy
as the one being replaced. Using a tire of the Maintain correct tire pressure. For the tire
same make (manufacturer) will prevent altera- pressure tables, see page 178.
tion of the driving characteristics of the vehicle.
Drive smoothly: avoid fast starts, hard
braking and tire screeching.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

175
07 Wheels and tires

Tire inflation

Inflation labels Under-inflation or over-inflation may cause


uneven treadwear patterns.

WARNING
Under-inflation is the most common
cause of tire failure and may result in
severe tire cracking, tread separation,
or "blowout," with unexpected loss of
vehicle control and increased risk of
injury.
Under-inflated tires reduce the load car-

G032520
G032513
rying capacity of your vehicle.

When weather temperature changes occur, tire


Tire inflation placard on Canadian models
inflation pressures also change. A 10-degree
Tire inflation placard on U.S. models temperature drop causes a corresponding
NOTE drop of 1 psi (7 kPa) in inflation pressure. Check
Check tire inflation pressure regularly.
The placards shown indicate inflation pres- your tire pressures frequently and adjust them
Tables listing the recommended inflation pres- sure for the tires installed on the car at the to the proper pressure, which can be found on
sure for your vehicle can be found on page factory only. the vehicle's tire information placard or certifi-
178. A tire inflation pressure placard is also
cation label.
located on the driver's side B-pillar (the struc-
Use a tire gauge to check the tire inflation pres-
tural member at the side of the vehicle, at the
sure, including the spare, at least once a month
07 rear of the driver's door opening). This placard
and before long trips. You are strongly urged
indicates the designation of the factory-moun-
to buy a reliable tire pressure gauge, as auto-
ted tires on your vehicle, as well as load limits
matic service station gauges may be inaccu-
and inflation pressure.
rate.
Use the recommended cold inflation pressure
for optimum tire performance and wear.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

176
07 Wheels and tires

Tire inflation

Checking tire pressure 2. Add air to reach the recommended air Speed ratings
pressure The speed ratings in the tables translate as fol-
Cold tires lows:
Inflation pressure should be checked when the 3. Replace the valve cap.
tires are cold. 4. Repeat this procedure for each tire, includ- M = 81 mph (130 km/h), V= 149 mph (240 km/
ing the spare. h), W= 168 mph (270 km/h)
The tires are considered to be cold when
they have the same temperature as the sur- 5. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there See also page 180 for an explanation of the
rounding (ambient) air. are no nails or other objects embedded designations on the sidewall of the tire.

This temperature is normally reached after the that could puncture the tire and cause an
car has been parked for at least 3 hours. air leak.

After driving a distance of approximately 1 mile 6. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are
(1.6 km), the tires are considered to be hot. If no gouges, cuts, bulges or other irregular-
you have to drive farther than this distance to ities.
pump your tire(s), check and record the tire
pressure first and add the appropriate air pres- NOTE
sure when you get to the pump. If you overfill the tire, release air by
If checking tire pressure when the tire is hot, pushing on the metal stem in the center
never "bleed" or reduce air pressure. The tires of the valve. Then recheck the pressure
are hot from driving and it is normal for pres- with your tire gauge.
sures to increase above recommended cold Some spare tires require higher inflation
pressures. A hot tire at or below recommended pressure than the other tires. Consult
cold inflation pressure could be significantly the tire inflation tables, see page 178,
under-inflated. or see the inflation pressure placard.
07
To check inflation pressure:
Load ratings
1. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire,
The load ratings in the tables above translate
then firmly press the tire gauge onto the
as follows:
valve.
91 = 1365 lbs (615 kg), 93 = 1433 lbs (650 kg),
99 = 1709 lbs (755 kg)

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

177
07 Wheels and tires

Inflation pressureU.S. models

Tire inflation pressure table tion placard for information specific to the tires
The following tire pressures are recommended installed on your vehicle at the factory.
by Volvo for your vehicle. Refer to the tire infla-

Tire size Cold tire pressure up to five persons psi (kPa)


Front Rear
205/55R16 91V M+S 32 (220) 32 (220)

205/50R17 93V 35 (240) 35 (240)


Extra Load M+S

215/45R18A 93W 35 (240) 35 (240)


Extra load

Temporary spare tire 61 (420) 61 (420)


T125/85R16 99M
A Tires of this type may not be mounted on vehicles equipped with the optional self-leveling system.

07

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

178
07 Wheels and tires

Inflation pressureCanadian models

Tire inflation pressure table tion placard for information specific to the tires
The following tire pressures are recommended installed on your vehicle at the factory.
by Volvo for your vehicle. Refer to the tire infla-

Tire size Cold tire pressures Optional pressure


Up to five persons Up to three personsA
psi (kPa) psi (kPa)
Front Rear Front Rear
205/55R16 91V M+S 36 (250) 36 (250) 30 (210) 30 (210)

205/50R17 93V Extra Load 36 (250) 36 (250) 35 (240) 32 (220)


M+S

215/45R18 93W Extra 36 (250) 36 (250) 35 (240) 32 (220)


loadB

Temporary spare tire 61 (420) 61 (420) 61 (420) 61 (420)


T125/85R16 99M
A Optional pressure may not be used for homologation of fuel consumption or emissions.
B Tires of this type may not be mounted on vehicles equipped with the optional self-leveling system.
07

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

179
07 Wheels and tires

Tire designations

Tire designations 15: The diameter of the wheel rim (in M+S or M/S = Mud and Snow, AT = All
inches). Terrain, AS = All Season
7 9
95: The tire's load index. In this example, a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number
load index of 95 equals a maximum load of (TIN): This begins with the letters "DOT"
1521 lbs (690 kg). and indicates that the tire meets all federal
6 8 standards. The next two numbers or letters
H: The tire's speed rating, or the maximum
are the plant code where it was manufac-
5 10 speed at which the tire is designed to be
driven for extended periods of time, carry- tured, the next two are the tire size code
4 11 ing a permissible load for the vehicle, and and the last four numbers represent the
with correct inflation pressure. For exam- week and year the tire was built. For exam-
3 12 ple, the numbers 317 mean the 31st week
ple, H indicates a speed rating of 130 mph
2 (210 km/h). of 1997. After 2000 the numbers go to four
G026442
digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th
1 week of 2001. The numbers in between are
NOTE
marketing codes used at the manufactur-
This information may not appear on the tire er's discretion. This information helps a tire
Federal law mandates that tire manufacturers because it is not required by law. manufacturer identify a tire for safety recall
place standardized information on the sidewall purposes.
of all tires (see the illustration). Tire Ply Composition and Material Used:
The following information is listed on the tire Indicates the number of plies indicates or
sidewall: the number of layers of rubber-coated fab-
ric in the tire tread and sidewall. Tire man-
The tire designation (the following figures are
ufacturers also must indicate the ply mate-
examples of a tire designation):
07 rials in the tire and the sidewall, which
215: The width of the tire (in millimeters) include steel, nylon, polyester, and others.
from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. The
larger the number, the wider the tire.
65: The ratio of the tire's height to its width.
R: Radial tire.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

180
07 Wheels and tires

Tire designations

Maximum Load: Indicates the maximum


load in pounds and kilograms that can be
carried by the tire. Refer to the vehicle's tire
information placard or the safety certifica-
tion label, located on the B-Pillar or the
driver's door or on the inside of the fuel filler
door on Canadian models, for the correct
tire pressure for your vehicle.
Treadwear, Traction, and Temperature
grades: See page 185 for more informa-
tion.
Maximum permissible inflation
pressure: The greatest amount of air pres-
sure that should ever be put in the tire. This
limit is set by the tire manufacturer.
The tire suppliers may have additional mark-
ings, notes or warnings such as standard load,
radial tubeless, etc.

07

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

181
07 Wheels and tires

Glossary of tire terminology

Terminology B-pillar: The structural member at the side B-pillar or on the inside of the fuel filler door
Tire information placard: A placard of the vehicle behind the front door. on Canadian models, and in the tire infla-
showing the OE (Original Equipment) tire Bead area of the tire: Area of the tire next tion table in this chapter.
sizes, recommended inflation pressure, to the rim. Cold tires: The tires are considered to be
and the maximum weight the vehicle can Sidewall of the tire: Area between the cold when they have the same temperature
carry. bead area and the tread. as the surrounding (ambient) air. This tem-
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A num- perature is normally reached after the car
Tread area of the tire: Area of the perim- has been parked for at least 3 hours.
ber on the sidewall of each tire providing eter of the tire that contacts the road when
information about the tire brand and man- mounted on the vehicle. Properly loading your vehicle will provide maxi-
ufacturing plant, tire size and date of man- mum return of vehicle design performance.
ufacturer. Rim: The metal support (wheel) for a tire or
a tire and tube assembly upon which the
Inflation pressure: A measure of the tire beads are seated.
amount of air in a tire.
Maximum load rating: a figure indicating
Standard load: A class of P-metric or Met- the maximum load in pounds and kilo-
ric tires designed to carry a maximum load grams that can be carried by the tire. This
at 35 psi [37 psi (2.5 bar) for Metric tires]. rating is established by the tire manufac-
Increasing the inflation pressure beyond turer.
this pressure will not increase the tires load
carrying capability. Maximum permissible inflation pres-
sure: the greatest amount of air pressure
Extra load: A class of P-metric or Metric that should ever be put in the tire. This limit
tires designed to carry a heavier maximum is set by the tire manufacturer.
load at 41 psi [43 psi (2.9 bar) for Metric
tires]. Increasing the inflation pressure Recommended tire inflation pressure:
beyond this pressure will not increase the inflation pressure, established by Volvo,
07 which is based on the type of tires that are
tires load carrying capability.
mounted on a vehicle at the factory. This
kPa: Kilopascal, a metric unit of air pres- inflation pressure is affected by the number
sure. of occupants in the car, the amount of
PSI: Pounds per square inch, a standard cargo, and the speed at which the vehicle
unit of air pressure. will be driven for a prolonged period. This
information can be found on the tire infla-
tion placard(s) located on the driver's side

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

182
07 Wheels and tires

Vehicle loading

Loading the vehicle Motor Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS/ (4) The resulting figure equals the available
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize yourself CMVSS) label. The total load on each axle must amount of cargo and luggage load capacity.
with the following terms for determining your never exceed its maximum permissible weight. For example, if the "XXX" amount equals
vehicle's weight ratings, with or without a 1400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lbs. pas-
Gross vehicle weight (GVW) sengers in your vehicle, the amount of available
trailer, from the vehicle's Federal/Canadian
The vehicle's curb weight + cargo + passen- cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS/
gers. (1400750 (5150) = 650 lbs.)
CMVSS) label, and the vehicle's tire informa-
tion placard: (5) Determine the combined weight of luggage
NOTE
and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That
Curb weight
The location of the various labels in your weight may not safely exceed the available
The weight of the vehicle including a full tank vehicle can be found on page 262. cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in
of fuel and all standard equipment. It does not
A table listing important weight limits for Step 4.
include passengers, cargo, or optional equip-
your vehicle can be found on page (6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load
ment.
265. from your trailer will be transferred to your vehi-
Capacity weight cle. Consult this manual1 to determine how this
All weight added to the curb weight, including reduces the available cargo and luggage load
cargo and optional equipment. When towing, Steps for Determining Correct Load
capacity of your vehicle.
trailer hitch tongue load is also part of cargo Limit
weight. (1) Locate the statement "the combined weight
of occupants and cargo should never exceed
NOTE XXX pounds" on your vehicle's placard.

For trailer towing information, please refer to (2) Determine the combined weight of the driver
the section "Towing a trailer", see and passengers that will be riding in your vehi-
page 160. cle. 07

(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver


Permissible axle weight and passengers from XXX kilograms or XXX
The maximum allowable weight that can be pounds.
carried by a single axle (front or rear). These
numbers are shown on the Federal/Canadian

1 See "Towing a trailer"


``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

183
07 Wheels and tires

Vehicle loading

WARNING
Exceeding the permissible axle weight,
gross vehicle weight, or any other
weight rating limits can cause tire over-
heating resulting in permanent defor-
mation or catastrophic failure.
Do not use replacement tires with lower
load carrying capacities than the tires
that were original equipment on the
vehicle because this will lower the vehi-
cle's GVW rating. Replacement tires
with a higher limit than the originals do
not increase the vehicle's GVW rating
limitations.

07

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

184
07 Wheels and tires

Uniform tire quality gradings

Uniform tire quality gradings faces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C WARNING
ALL PASSENGER VEHICLE TIRES MUST may have poor traction performance. The trac-
tion grade assigned to this tire is based on The temperature grade for this tire is estab-
CONFORM TO FEDERAL SAFETY lished for a tire that is properly inflated and
REQUIREMENTS IN ADDITION TO THESE braking (straight-ahead) traction tests and is
not overloaded. Excessive speed, under-
GRADES not a measure of cornering (turning) traction. inflation, or excessive loading, either sepa-
rately or in combination, can cause heat
Quality grades can be found, where appli-
WARNING buildup and tire failure.
cable, on the tire sidewall between the tread
shoulder and maximum section width. For The traction grade assigned to this tire is
example: based on braking (straight-ahead) traction
tests and is not a measure of cornering
Treadwear 200 Traction AA (turning) traction.
Temperature A
TEMPERATURE
TREADWEAR The temperature grades are AA (the highest),
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating A, B, and C, representing the tire's resistance
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested to the generation of heat and its ability to dis-
under controlled conditions on a specified gov- sipate heat when tested under controlled con-
ernment test course. For example, a tire gra- ditions on a specified indoor laboratory test
ded 150 would wear one and one half (1 1/2) wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause
times as well on the government course as a the material of the tire to degenerate and
tire graded 100. The relative performance of reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can
tires depends upon the actual conditions of lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corre-
their use, however, and many depart signifi- sponds to a minimum level of performance that
cantly from the norm due to variation in driving all passenger vehicle tires must meet under the 07
habits, maintenance practices and differences Federal Motor Safety Standard No. 109.
in road characteristics and climate. Grades B and A represent higher levels of per-
formance on the laboratory test wheel than the
TRACTION
minimum required by law.
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are
AA, A, B, and C, as measured under controlled
conditions on specified government test sur-

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

185
07 Wheels and tires

Snow chains, snow tires, studded tires

Snow chains CAUTION ure to do so could reduce traction to an


Snow chains can be used on your Volvo with unsafe level or adversely affect handling.
the following restrictions:
Check local regulations regarding the
Do not mix tires of different design as this
use of snow chains before installing.
could also negatively affect overall tire road
Snow chains should be installed on front Always follow the chain manufacturer's grip.
wheels only. Use only Volvo approved installation instructions carefully. Install
snow chains. chains as tightly as possible and
Winter tires wear more quickly on dry roads
in warm weather. They should be removed
If accessory, aftermarket or "custom" tires retighten periodically.
when the winter driving season has ended.
and wheels are installed and are of a size Never exceed the chain manufacturer's
different than the original tires and wheels, specified maximum speed limit. (Under
Studded tires should be run-in 300
chains in some cases CANNOT be used. 600 miles (5001000 km) during which the
no circumstances should you exceed
Sufficient clearances between chains and car should be driven as smoothly as pos-
31 mph (50 km/h).
brakes, suspension and body components sible to give the studs the opportunity to
must be maintained. Avoid bumps, holes or sharp turns seat properly in the tires. The tires should
when driving with snow chains. have the same rotational direction
Some strap-on type chains will interfere
throughout their entire lifetime.
with brake components and therefore The handling of the vehicle can be
CANNOT be used. adversely affected when driving with
chains. Avoid fast or sharp turns as well NOTE
All Wheel Drive models: Snow chains as locked wheel braking.
should only be installed on the front Please consult state or provincial regula-
wheels. Only chains adapted for AWD tions restricting the use of studded winter
models should be used. tires before installing such tires.
Snow tires, studded tires
Consult your Volvo retailer for additional snow
chain information. Tires for winter use:
Owners who live in or regularly commute
07 through areas with sustained periods of
snow or icy driving conditions are strongly
advised to fit suitable winter tires to help
retain the highest degree of traction.
It is important to install winter tires on all
four wheels to help retain traction during
cornering, braking, and accelerating. Fail-

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

186
07 Wheels and tires

Temporary spare

Temporary spare
The spare tire in your car is called a "Temporary
Spare".
Recommended tire pressure (see the placard
on the B-pillar or on the fuel filler door) should
be maintained irrespective of which position on
the car the temporary spare tire is used on.
In the event of damage to this tire, a new one
can be purchased from your Volvo retailer.

WARNING
Current legislation prohibits the use of the
"Temporary Spare" tire other than as a tem-
porary replacement for a punctured tire. It
must be replaced as soon as possible by a
standard tire. Road holding and handling
may be affected with the "Temporary
Spare" in use. Do not exceed a speed of
50 mph (80 km/h) with the "Temporary
Spare" in use.

CAUTION
The car must not be driven with wheels of 07
different dimensions or with a spare tire
other than the one that came with the car.
The use of different size wheels can seri-
ously damage your car's transmission.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

187
07 Wheels and tires

Wheel nuts

Wheel nuts WARNING


Never use the short type of nut for alumi-
nium wheels. This could cause the wheel to
come loose.

Aluminum wheels high nut


Only the high type of nut can be used for alu-
minum wheels. This is considerably different
from other types of nut because it has a rotat-
ing conical thrust washer.

G020324 NOTE
This nut can also be used on steel wheels.

Low nut. Lockable wheel nut


If steel wheels with lockable wheel nuts are
High nut. used in combination with wheel covers, the
There are two different types of wheel nut, lockable wheel nut must be fitted to the stud
depending on whether the wheels are steel or nearest the air valve. The wheel cover cannot
aluminum. otherwise be installed on the wheel.

Steel rims low nut


07 Steel rims are normally secured using the low
type of nut, although steel rims may also use
the high type.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

188
07 Wheels and tires

Tire rotation

Contact a Volvo workshop if you are an aid in detecting a suspension problem. Each
unsure about the tread depth. tire, if left in place, tells a story about the sus-
pension. Tire rotation, on the other hand, could
Tire rotation make suspension wear harder to detect. Early
Your vehicle has no recommended tire rota- detection is very important, because suspen-
tion. The following information is intended to sion problems can make tire wear worse.
help you understand why.
If you do rotate your tires
Tread set Please follow the tire manufacturer's recom-
As a tire ages and the rubber cures, front and mendations, as outlined in the tire manufactur-
rear tires set at different angles. Therefore, if ers tire warranty pamphlet.
tires are rotated, the tread will eventually set at
an angle that is a compromise. Even if ride, Your Volvo retailer can also provide guidance
G020325 handling, and road noise may still seem based on your particular driving circumstan-
acceptable, they may not be optimal. Further, ces.
The arrows shows the direction of rotation of the tires that are rotated, but not on a regular basis,
tire may actually cause more tire noise, faster tire
wear, and unpleasant changes in steering feel
Summer and winter tires and vehicle handling.
When switching between summer and
winter tires, mark the tires to indicate A tire that can fully adapt to its position will
where they were mounted on the car, e.g., provide better steering feel, lower tire noise,
LF = left front, RR = right rear and better fuel economy.
Tires with tread designed to roll in only one Braking stability performance
direction are marked with an arrow on the Your vehicle is driven mainly by the front tires,
sidewall. which will wear faster. This can be beneficial. 07
Incorrectly mounted tires impair the car's Having more tread on the rear tires will help
braking properties and ability to force reduce oversteer. Oversteer is when a vehicle
aside rain, snow and slush. wants to keep turning because of momentum
and dynamic forces on its suspension.
The tires with the most tread should always
be at the rear (to reduce the risk of skid- Suspension wear diagnostics
ding). Every suspension needs periodic inspection
and maintenance. A tire's wear pattern can be

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

189
07 Wheels and tires

Changing a wheel

Changing a wheel

G020332

G024532
G020331

Jack attachment points


5. With the car still on the ground, use the lug
The spare tire, jack, and crank are located wrench to loosen the wheel nuts 1/21 turn 7. Raise the vehicle until the wheel to be
under the carpet on the floor of the trunk. by exerting downward pressure. Turn the changed is lifted off the ground.
nuts counterclockwise to loosen. 8. Unscrew the wheel nuts completely and
To change a tire:
6. There are two jack attachment points on carefully remove the wheel so as not to
1. Apply the parking brake. each side of the car. Position the jack cor- damage the threads on the studs.
2. Put the gear selector in Park (P) or reverse rectly in the attachment (see the illustration)
on models with a manual transmission. and crank while simultaneously guiding the
base of the jack to the ground. The base of
07 3. Block the wheels that are on the ground the jack must be flat on a level, firm, non-
with wooden blocks or large stones. slippery surface. Before raising the car,
4. Remove the wheel cap (where applicable) check that the jack is still correctly posi-
using the lug wrench in the tool bag. tioned in the attachment.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

190
07 Wheels and tires

Changing a wheel

WARNING Installing the wheel The jack (certain models) and tools should be
1. Clean the contact surfaces on the wheel returned to their correct storage places after
The jack must correctly engage the jack
and hub. use.
attachment.
2. Lift the wheel and place it on the hub. On vehicles equipped with a jack and
Be sure the jack is on a firm, level, non- spare wheel, the jack should be cranked
slippery surface. 3. Install the wheel nuts and tighten hand- down to the position shown in the illustra-
Never allow any part of your body to be tight. Using the lug wrench, tighten cross- tion.
extended under a car supported by a wise until all nuts are snug.
jack.
On vehicles equipped with the tire sealing
4. Lower the vehicle to the ground and alter- system, the jack should be cranked down
Use the jack intended for the car when nately tighten the bolts crosswise to as far as possible and returned to its stor-
changing a tire. For any other job, use 81 ft. lbs. (110 Nm). age position in the foam block.
stands to support the car.
5. Install the wheel cap (where applicable).
Apply the parking brake and put the WARNING
gear selector in the Park (P) position or
The jack and any tools should always be
reverse on models with a manual trans- Returning the jack to its storage space returned to their proper storage compart-
mission. ments after use to help keep them securely
Block the wheels standing on the in place in the event of sudden braking, etc.
ground, use rigid wooden blocks or
large stones.
The jack should be kept well-greased
and clean, and should not be damaged.
No objects should be placed between
the base of jack and the ground, or
between the jack and the attachment 07
bar on the vehicle.

G029335

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

191
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

Introduction NOTE Tire sealing systemoverview


Certain models are equipped with a tire sealing
system that enables you to temporarily seal a
The tire sealing system is only intended
to seal holes on the tires tread area, not
hole in the tread surface and re-inflate a flat tire, the sidewall.
or to adjust a tires inflation pressure.
Tires with large holes or tears cannot be
The system consists of an air compressor, a repaired with the tire sealing system.
container for the sealing compound, wiring to
connect the system to the vehicles electrical
system via one of the 12-volt sockets, and a WARNING
hose used to connect the system to the tires After using the tire sealing system, the
inflation valve. vehicle should not be driven farther than
The 12-volt sockets are located in the front approximately 120 miles (200 km).

G020400
tunnel console and on the rear side of the tun- Have the tire inspected by a trained and
nel console, in the rear seat. qualified Volvo service technician as
soon as possible to determine if it can
Accessing the tire sealing system be permanently repaired or must be Speed limit sticker
The tire sealing system is stowed under the replaced.
floor of the trunk. To access it: On/Off switch
The vehicle should not be driven faster
1. Fold up or remove any carpet or other floor than 50 mph (80 km/h) while using a tire Electrical wire
covering. that has been temporarily repaired with
the tire sealing system. Bottle holder (orange cover)
2. Open the floor hatch.
3. Lift out the tire sealing system. After using the tire sealing system, drive Protective hose cover
carefully and avoid abrupt steering
07 Air release knob
maneuvers and sudden stops.
Hose
Bottle with sealing compound
Air pressure gauge

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

192
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

WARNING Inhalation: Move the person to fresh air. Stage 1: The hole is sealed by pumping
If irritation persists, get medical atten- sealing compound into the tire. The car is
Please keep the following points in mind tion. then driven a short distance to distribute
when using the tire sealing system: the sealing compound in the tire.
The sealing compound bottle (no. 8 in
the illustration) contains 1.2-Ethanol Tire sealing systemtemporarily NOTE
and natural rubber-latex. These sub- repairing a flat tire
stances are harmful if swallowed. Do not remove any foreign objects (nails,
etc.) from the tire before using the sealing
The contents of this bottle may cause system.
allergic skin reactions or otherwise be
potentially harmful to the skin, the cen-
tral nervous system, and the eyes. Stage 2: The tires inflation pressure is
checked and adjusted if necessary.
Precautions:
Keep out of reach of children. WARNING
Do not ingest the contents. Never leave the tire sealing system
Avoid prolonged or repeated contact unattended when it is operating.
with the skin. Keep the tire sealing system away from
Hands should be washed thoroughly children.
after handling. Be sure the vehicle is parked safely off
First aid: the road and away from moving traffic.
Skin: Wash affected areas of skin with Apply the parking brake.
soap and water. Get medical attention
if symptoms occur. Stage 1: Sealing the hole 07
Eyes: Flush with plenty of water for least 1. Open the cover on the tire sealing kit.

G014338
15 minutes, occasionally lifting the
upper and lower eyelids. Get medical 2. Peel off the speed limit sticker and affix it
attention if symptoms occur. to the steering wheel hub where it will be
Temporarily repairing a flat tire is done in two clearly visible to the driver.
stages:

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

193
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

3. Ensure that the on/off switch is in position WARNING WARNING


0 (the 0 side of the switch should be
pressed down). The bottle is equipped with a catch to keep Never stand next to the tire being inflated
it securely in place and help prevent sealing when the compressor is in operation.
4. Put on the gloves included in the tire seal- compound leakage. Once in place, the bot-
ing system. tle cannot be unscrewed. This must be done If cracks, bubbles, etc. form on the tire,
by a trained and qualified Volvo service switch off the compressor immediately.

WARNING
technician. If there is visible damage to the sidewall
or the rim, the tire cannot be repaired.
Contact with the sealing compound may The vehicle should not be driven if this
7. Remove the valve cap from the tires infla-
cause skin irritation. If contact occurs, wash occurs. Contact a towing service or
the affected area immediately with soap and tion valve and screw the tire sealing sys-
Volvo On Call Roadside Assistance if
water. tems hose connector onto the valve as
applicable.
tightly as possible by hand.
5. Unscrew the orange cover over the bottle 8. Connect the electrical wire to the nearest
holder and unscrew the cap on the bottle 12-volt socket in the vehicle. NOTE
of sealing compound. 9. Start the vehicles engine. The air pressure gauge will temporarily
show an increase in pressure to approxi-
NOTE 10. Start the tire sealing systems compressor mately 88 psi (6 bar) while the sealing com-
by pressing the on/off switch to position I. pound is being pumped into the tire. The
Do not break the seal on the bottle. This pressure should return to a normal level
occurs automatically when the bottle is after approximately 30 seconds.
screwed into the holder.
11. Within seven minutes, inflate the tire to
6. Screw the bottle into the bottle holder. between 2244 psi (1.83.0 bar). Switch
07 off the compressor briefly to get a clear
reading from the pressure gauge. The
compressor should not be used for more
than 10 minutes at a time to avoid over-
heating.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

194
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

CAUTION NOTE the tire by turning the air release knob


counterclockwise.
The compressor should not be used for Safely stow the tire sealing system in a
more than 10 minutes at a time to avoid convenient place as it will soon be used
overheating. CAUTION
again to check the tires inflation pres-
sure. The compressor should not be used for
more than 10 minutes at a time to avoid
WARNING The empty bottle of sealing compound
overheating.
cannot be removed from the bottle
If the pressure remains below 22 psi (1.8 holder. Consult a trained and qualified
bar) after approximately seven minutes, turn Volvo service technician to have the
off the compressor. In this case, the hole is WARNING
bottle removed and properly disposed
too large to be sealed and the vehicle should If you interrupt your trip for more than 1
not be driven. of.
hour, check the inflation pressure in the
damaged tire again before continuing.
12. Switch off the compressor and disconnect WARNING
the electrical wire from the 12-volt socket. If heavy vibrations, unsteady steering Replacing the sealing compound
13. Unscrew the hose from the tires inflation behavior, or noises should occur while driv- container
valve and reinstall the valve cap. ing, reduce speed and park the vehicle in a The sealing compound container must be
safe place. Recheck the tire for bumps, replaced if:
14. Immediately drive the vehicle for approxi- cracks, or other visible damage, and
mately 2 miles (3 km) at a maximum speed recheck its inflation pressure. If the pressure the tire sealing system has been used to
of 50 mph (80 km/h) to distribute the seal- is below 19 psi (1.3 bar), do not continue repair a tire
driving. Have the vehicle towed to a trained
ing compound in the tire.
and qualified Volvo service technician.
the containers expiration date has passed
(see the date on decal).

Stage 2: Checking inflation pressure 07


1. Connect the tire sealing system as descri-
bed in stage 1.
2. Refer to the inflation pressure tablesfor the
correct inflation pressure. If the tire needs
to be inflated, start the tire sealing systems
compressor. If necessary, release air from

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

195
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Sealing System

NOTE 6. Start the vehicles engine. 9. Turn off the compressor (press the on/off
switch to position 0) when the correct infla-
After use, the sealing compound bottle,
WARNING tion pressure has been reached.
the hose, and certain other system
components must be replaced. Please The vehicles engine should be running 10. Unscrew the hose from the tires inflation
consult your Volvo retailer for replace- when the tire sealing system is used to valve and reinstall the valve cap.
ment parts. avoid battery drain. Therefore, be sure 11. Disconnect the electrical wire from the
the vehicle is parked in a well ventilated
If the sealing compound bottles expi- 12-volt socket.
ration date has passed, please take it to place, or outdoors, before using the sys-
a Volvo retailer or a recycling station tem.
that can properly dispose of harmful Children should never be left unattended
substances. in the vehicle when the engine is running.

7. Check the tires inflation pressure on the


Inflating tires gauge. Switch off the compressor briefly to
The tire sealing system can be used to inflate get a clear reading from the pressure
the tires. To do so: gauge.
1. Park the car in a safe place. 8. Refer to the tire inflation tables for the cor-
2. The compressor should be switched off. rect inflation pressure. If the tire needs to
Ensure that the on/off switch is in posi- be inflated, start the tire sealing systems
tion 0 (the 0 side of the switch should be compressor (press the on/off switch to
pressed down). position I). If necessary, release air from the
tire by turning the air release knob coun-
3. Take out the electrical wire and hose. terclockwise.
07
4. Remove the valve cap from the tires infla-
tion valve and screw the hose connector CAUTION
onto the valve as tightly as possible by
The compressor should not be used for
hand. more than 10 minutes at a time to avoid
5. Connect the electrical wire to the nearest overheating.
12-volt socket in the vehicle.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

196
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)

Introduction NOTE er's responsibility to maintain correct tire pres-


The tire pressure monitoring system uses sen- sure, even if under-inflation has not reached
If a fault occurs in TPMS, the tire pressure the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low
sors mounted in the tire valves to check infla- warning light will flash for approximately
tion pressure levels. When the vehicle is tire pressure telltale.
1 minute and TIRE PRESS SYST
moving at a speed of approximately 20 mph SERVICE REQUIRED will be displayed. Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
(30 km/h) or faster, these sensors transmit TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when
inflation pressure data to a receiver located in the system is not operating properly. The
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),
the vehicle. TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with
should be checked monthly when cold and
inflated to the inflation pressure recommended the low tire pressure telltale. When the system
NOTE by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for
USA FCC ID: KR5S122780002 placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your approximately one minute and then remain
vehicle has tires of a different size than the size continuously illuminated. This sequence will
This device complies with part 15 of the continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as
FCC rules. Operation is subject to the fol- indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation
pressure label, you should determine the long as the malfunction exists. When the mal-
lowing conditions: (1) This device may not
cause harmful interference, and (2) this proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.) function indicator is illuminated, the system
device must accept any interference may not be able to detect or signal low tire
received, including interference that may As an added safety feature, your vehicle has pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may
cause undesired operation. been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring occur for a variety of reasons, including the
system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pres- installation of replacement or alternate tires or
sure telltale when one or more of your tires is wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS
When low inflation pressure is detected, TPMS significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when
will light up the tire pressure warning light (also from functioning properly. Always check the
the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one
referred to as a telltale) in the instrument panel, should stop and check your tires as soon as
and will display a message in the text window. or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to
possible, and inflate them to the proper pres- ensure that the replacement or alternate tires
The wording of this message is determined by sure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated 07
the degree of inflation pressure loss. and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to
tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to function properly.
tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel
efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the
vehicle's handling and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute
for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driv-

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

197
07 Wheels and tires

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)

NOTE will erase the warning text and the warning Volvo does not recommend moving sen-
light will go out. sors back and forth between sets of
TPMS indicates low tire pressure but wheels.
does not replace normal tire mainte-
WARNING
nance. For information on correct tire NOTE
pressure, please refer to the tables Incorrect inflation pressure could lead to tire
beginning, see page 178, or consult failure, resulting in a loss of control of the If you change to tires with a different
your Volvo retailer. vehicle. recommended inflation pressure, the
TPMS system must be recalibrated to
The tire pressure warning light will not
these tires. This must be done by an
identify which tire is underinflated. Be Changing wheels with TPMS
sure to check all four tires. authorized Volvo retailer or workshop.
Please note the following when changing or
A certain amount of air seepage from replacing the factory installed TPMS wheels/ If a tire is changed, or if the TPMS sen-
the tires occurs naturally and tire pres- tires on the vehicle: sor is moved to another wheel, the sen-
sure fluctuates with seasonal changes sor's seal, nut, and valve core should be
Only the factory-mounted wheels are replaced.
in temperature. Always check tire pres- equipped with TPMS sensors in the valves.
sure regularly. When installing TPMS sensors, the
If the vehicle is equipped with a temporary vehicle must be parked for at least
spare tire, this tire does not have a TPMS 15 minutes with the ignition off. If the
Erasing warning messages sensor. vehicle is driven within 15 minutes, a
When a low tire pressure warning message has If wheels without TPMS sensors are moun- TPMS error message will be displayed.
been displayed, and the tire pressure warning ted on the vehicle, TIRE PRESS SYST
light has come on: SERVICE REQUIRED will be displayed
each time the vehicle is driven above CAUTION
1. Use a tire pressure gauge to check the
inflation pressure of all four tires. 25 mph (40 km/h) for 10 minutes or more. When inflating tires with TPMS valves, press
07 Once TPMS sensors are properly installed, the pump's mouthpiece straight onto the
2. Re-inflate the tire(s) to the correct pressure valve to help avoid bending or otherwise
the warning message should not reappear.
(consult the tire pressure placard or the damaging the valve.
If the message is still displayed, drive the
tables, see page 178 ).
vehicle for several minutes at a speed of
3. In certain cases, it may be necessary to 20 mph (30 km/h) or faster to erase the
drive the vehicle for several minutes at a message.
speed of 20 mph (30 km/h) or faster. This Volvo recommends that TPMS sensors be
fitted on all wheels used on the vehicle.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

198
07 Wheels and tires

07

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

199
Washing and cleaning the car............................................................... 202

G020920
Paint touch up....................................................................................... 206

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

200
CAR CARE

08
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
08 Car care

Washing and cleaning the car

Washing the car Tar spots can be removed with kerosene fully.Solvents or stain removers should not be
The following points should be kept in mind or tar remover after the car has been used.
when washing and cleaning the car: washed.

The car should be washed at regular inter-


A stiff-bristle brush and lukewarm soapy CAUTION
water can be used to clean the wiper
vals since dirt, dust, insects and tar spots
blades. Frequent cleaning of the wind- Avoid waxing or polishing plastic or rub-
adhere to the paint and may cause dam- ber components
shield and wiper blades improves visibility
age. To help prevent corrosion, it is partic- Polishing chromed strips can wear
considerably and also helps prolong the
ularly important to wash the car frequently away or damage the surface
service life of the wiper blades.
in the wintertime when salt has been used
on the roads. Wash off the dirt from the underside (wheel Polishes containing abrasive sub-
housings, fenders, etc). stances should not be used
Avoid washing your car in direct sunlight.
Doing so may cause detergents and wax In areas of high industrial fallout, more fre-
to dry out and become abrasive. To avoid quent washing is recommended.
scratching, use lukewarm water to soften After cleaning the engine, the spark plug
the dirt before you wash with a soft wells should be inspected for water and
sponge, and plenty of sudsy water. blown dry if necessary.
Bird droppings: Remove from paintwork
as soon as possible. Otherwise the finish NOTE
may be permanently damaged.
When washing the car, remember to remove
A detergent can be used to facilitate the dirt from the drain holes in the doors and
softening of dirt and oil. sills.
A water-soluble grease solvent may be
used in cases of sticky dirt. However, use Exterior components
a wash place equipped with a drainage Volvo recommends the use of special cleaning
separator. products, available at your Volvo retailer, for
Dry the car with a clean chamois and cleaning colored plastic, rubber, or ornamental
remember to clean the drain holes in the components such as chromed strips on the
08 doors and rocker panels. exterior of your vehicle. The instructions for
using these products should be followed care-

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

202
08 Car care

Washing and cleaning the car

CAUTION Keeping the underbody clean is most impor- Exterior lighting


tant, especially in the winter. Some automatic Condensation may form temporarily on the
During high pressure washing, the washers do not have facilities for washing the inside of the lenses of exterior lights such as
spray mouthpiece must never be closer underbody. headlights, fog lights, or taillights. This is nor-
to the vehicle than 13" (30 cm). Do not
mal and the lights are designed to withstand
spray into the locks.
CAUTION moisture. Normally, condensation will dissi-
Dirt, snow, etc., on the headlights can pate after the lights have been on for a short
reduce lighting capacity considerably. Before driving into an automatic car
time.
Clean the headlights regularly, for wash, turn off the optional rain sensor
example when refueling. to avoid damaging the windshield wip- Polishing and Waxing
ers.
When washing or steam cleaning the Normally, polishing is not required during
engine, avoid spraying water or steam Make sure that side view mirrors, auxil- the first year after delivery, however, wax-
directly on the electrical components or iary lamps, etc, are secure, and that any ing may be beneficial.
toward the rear side of the engine. antenna(s) are retracted or removed.
Before applying polish or wax the vehicle
Otherwise there is risk of the machine must be washed and dried. Tar spots can
Always close the moonroof (option) and
dislodging them
sun shade before washing your vehicle. be removed with kerosene or tar remover.
Chromed wheels: Clean chrome- Difficult spots may require a fine rubbing
Never use abrasive cleaning agents on
plated wheels using the same deter- compound.
the moonroof.
gents used for the body of the vehicle. After polishing use liquid or paste wax.
Never use wax on the rubber seals Aggressive wheel-cleaning agents can
around the moonroof. permanently stain chrome-plated Several commercially available products
wheels. contain both polish and wax.

Automatic washing simple and quick Waxing alone does not substitute for pol-
ishing a dull surface.
We do NOT recommend washing your car in an WARNING
automatic wash during the first six months A wide range of polymer-based waxes can
(because the paint will not have hardened suf- When the car is driven immediately after be purchased today. These waxes are easy
ficiently). being washed, apply the brakes several to use and produce a long-lasting, high-
times in order to remove any moisture gloss finish that protects the bodywork
An automatic wash is a simple and quick way from the brake linings. against oxidation, road dirt and fading.
to clean your car, but it is worth remembering 08
that it may not be as thorough as when you
Engine cleaning agents should not be Do not polish or wax your vehicle in direct
used when the engine is warm. This sunlight (the surface of the vehicle should
yourself go over the car with sponge and water. constitutes a fire risk. not be warmer than 113 F (45 C).

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

203
08 Car care

Washing and cleaning the car

CAUTION Leather care 3. Dampen the stain thoroughly with the


Volvo's leather upholstery is manufactured sponge. Let the sponge absorb the stain,
Volvo does not recommend the use of long- with a protectant to repel soiling. Over time, do not rub.
life or durable paint protection coatings,
some of which may claim to prevent pitting, sunlight, grease and dirt can break down the 4. Dry the stain with soft paper towels or a
fading, oxidation, etc. These coatings have protection. Staining, cracking, scuffing, and towel, and allow the leather to dry com-
not been tested by Volvo for compatibility fading can result. pletely.
with your vehicle's clear coat. Some of them Volvo offers an easy-to-use, non-greasy
may cause the clear coat to soften, crack, Protecting leather upholstery
or cloud. Damage caused by application of leather care kit formulated to clean and beau- 1. Put a small amount of protectant cream on
paint protection coatings may not be cov- tify your vehicle's leather, and to renew the a cloth and apply a thin coating of cream
ered under your vehicle's paint warranty. protective qualities of its finish. The cleaner to the upholstery with light circular move-
removes dirt and oil buildup. The light cream ments.
protectant restores a barrier against soil and
Upholstery care sunlight. 2. Allow the leather to dry for 20 minutes.

Volvo also offers a special leather softener that This will help the leather resist staining and
Fabric
should be applied after the cleaner and pro- protect against sunlight's harmful UV rays.
Clean with soapy water or a detergent. For
more difficult spots caused by oil, ice cream, tectant. It leaves leather soft and smooth, and
shoe polish, grease, etc., use a clothing/fabric reduces friction between leather and other fin-
stain remover. Consult your Volvo retailer. ishes in the vehicle.
Volvo recommends cleaning, protecting and
Interior plastic components conditioning your vehicle's leather two to four
Cleaning interior plastic components should times a year. Ask your Volvo retailer about
be done with a cleaning agent specially Leather Care Kit 951 0251 and Leather Soft-
designed for this purpose. Consult your Volvo ener 943 7429.
retailer.
Cleaning leather upholstery
Alcantera suede-like material 1. Pour leather cleaner on a damp sponge
Suede-like upholstery can be cleaned with a and squeeze it until the cleaner foams.
soft cloth and mild soap solution.
08 2. Apply the foam to the stain by moving the
sponge with circular movements.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

204
08 Car care

Washing and cleaning the car

CAUTION Cleaning floor mats


The floor mats should be vacuumed or brushed
Under no circumstances should gaso-
clean regularly, especially during winter when
line, naphtha or similar cleaning agents
be used on the plastic or the leather
they should be taken out for drying. Spots on
since these can cause damage. textile mats can be removed with a mild deter-
gent. For best protection in winter, Volvo rec-
Take extra care when removing stains ommends the use of Volvo rubber floor mats.
such as ink or lipstick since the coloring Consult your Volvo retailer.
can spread.
Use solvents sparingly. Too much sol-
vent can damage the seat padding.
Start from the outside of the stain and
work toward the center.
Sharp objects (e.g. pencils or pens in a
pocket) or Velcro fasteners on clothing
may damage the textile upholstery.
Clothing that is not colorfast, such as
new jeans or suede garments, may stain
the upholstery.

Cleaning the seat belts


Clean only with lukewarm water and a mild
soap solution.

08

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

205
08 Car care

Paint touch up

Touching up minor paint damage Minor stone chips and scratches NOTE
Paint damage requires immediate attention to Material:
When touching up the vehicle, it should be
avoid rusting. Make it a habit to check the finish
regularly - when washing the vehicle for
Primer can clean and dry. The surface temperature
should be above 60 F (15 C).
instance. Touch-up if necessary. Paint touch-up pen
If the stone chip has not penetrated down
Paint repairs require special equipment and Brush
to the metal and an undamaged layer of
skill. Contact a trained and authorized Volvo Masking tape paint remains, the touch-up paint can be
service technician for any extensive damage. applied as soon as the spot has been
Minor scratches can be repaired by using cleaned.
Volvo touch-up paint.
Deep scratches
Color code 1. Place a strip of masking tape over the dam-
aged surface. Pull the tape off so that any
loose flakes of paint adhere to it.
2. Thoroughly mix the primer and apply it with
a small brush. When the primer surface is
dry, the paint can be applied using a brush.
Mix the paint thoroughly; apply several thin

G020345
paint coats and let dry after each applica-
tion.
3. If there is a longer scratch, you may want
to protect surrounding paint by masking it
off.
G031024

08 When ordering touch-up paint from your Volvo


retailer, make sure you have the right color.
Use the paint code indicated on the model
plate (1 in the illustration).

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

206
08 Car care

08

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

207
Volvo maintenance................................................................................ 210
Maintaining your car.............................................................................. 212
Hood..................................................................................................... 214
Engine compartment............................................................................. 215
Engine oil............................................................................................... 216
Fluids..................................................................................................... 218
Wiper blades......................................................................................... 220
Battery................................................................................................... 221
Replacing bulbs.................................................................................... 223

G020922
Fuses..................................................................................................... 230

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

208
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICING

09
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Volvo maintenance

General Maintenance Service Records Information booklet for


Volvo advises you to follow the maintenance Your Volvo passed several major inspections detailed information concerning each of the
program outlined in the Warranty and Service before it was delivered to you, in accordance warranties.
Records Information booklet. This mainte- with Volvo specifications. The maintenance
nance program contains inspections and serv- procedures outlined in the Warranty and Serv- Periodic maintenance helps minimize
ices necessary for the proper function of your ice Records Information booklet, many of emissions
vehicle. The maintenance services contain which will positively affect your vehicle's emis- Periodic maintenance will help keep your vehi-
several checks that require special tools and sions, should be performed as indicated. It is cle running well. Your Warranty and Service
training, and therefore must be performed by a recommended that receipts for vehicle emis- Records Information booklet provides a com-
qualified technician. To keep your Volvo in top sion maintenance be retained in case ques- prehensive periodic maintenance schedule up
condition, specify time-tested and proven tions arise concerning maintenance. Inspec- to 150,000 miles (240,000 km) of vehicle main-
Genuine Volvo Parts and Accessories. tion and maintenance should also be tenance. The schedule includes components
performed anytime a malfunction is observed that affect vehicle emissions. This page
or suspected.
The Federal Clean Air Act U.S describes some of the emission-related com-
The Federal Clean Air Act requires vehicle ponents.
manufacturers to furnish written instructions to Applicable warranties U.S/Canada
the ultimate purchaser to assure the proper In accordance with applicable U.S. and Cana- Vehicle Event Data (Black Box)
servicing and function of the components that dian regulations, the following list of warranties Your vehicle's driving and safety systems
control emissions. These services, which are is provided. employ computers that monitor, and share
listed in the "Warranty and Service Records
Information" booklet, are not covered by the
New Vehicle Limited Warranty with each other, information about your vehi-
Parts and Accessories Limited Warranty cle's operation. One or more of these comput-
warranty. You will be required to pay for labor ers may store what they monitor, either during
and material used. Corrosion Protection Limited Warranty
normal vehicle operation or in a crash or near-
Seat Belt and Supplemental Restraint Sys- crash event. Stored information may be read
tems Limited Warranty and used by:
Emission Design and Defect Warranty
Volvo Car Corporation
Emission Performance Warranty
service and repair facilities
These are the federal warranties; other warran-
ties are provided as required by state/provin-
cial law. Refer to your separate Warranty and

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

210
09 Maintenance and servicing

Volvo maintenance 09

law enforcement or government agencies


others who may assert a legal right to
know, or who obtain your consent to know
such information.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

211
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Maintaining your car

Owner maintenance As needed: How Do States Use OBD II for Emission


Periodic maintenance requirements and inter- Wash the car, including the undercarriage, Inspections?
vals are described in your vehicle's Warranty to reduce wear that can be caused by a Many states connect a computer directly to a
and Service Records Information booklet. buildup of dirt, and corrosion that can be vehicle's OBD II system. The inspector can
caused by salt residues. then read "faults." In some states, this type of
The following points can be carried out
between the normally scheduled maintenance Clean leaves and twigs from air intake inspection has replaced the tailpipe emission
vents at the base of the windshield, and test.
services.
from other places where they may collect.
How Can My Vehicle Fail OBD II Emission
Each time the car is refueled:
NOTE Inspection?
Check the engine oil level.
Your vehicle can fail OBD II emission inspec-
Clean the windshield, windshield wipers, Complete service information for qualified tion for any of the following reasons.
headlights, and taillights. technicians is available online for purchase
or subscription at www.volvotechinfo.com. If your Check Engine (MIL) light is lit, your
Monthly: vehicle may fail inspection.
Check cold tire pressure in all tires. Inspect If your vehicle's Check Engine light was lit,
the tires for wear. Emission inspection readiness but went out without any action on your
Check that engine coolant and other fluid
What is an Onboard Diagnostic System
part, OBD II will still have a recorded fault.
levels are between the indicated "min" and Your vehicle may pass or fail, depending
"max" markings. (OBD II)? on the inspection practices in your area.
OBD II is part of your vehicle's computerized
Clean interior glass surfaces with a glass engine management system. It stores diagnos- If you had recent service that required dis-
cleaner and soft paper towels. connecting the battery, OBD II diagnostic
tic information about your vehicle's emission
Wipe driver information displays with a soft information may be incomplete and "not
controls. It can light the Check Engine light
cloth. ready" for inspection. A vehicle that is not
(MIL) if it detects an emission control "fault." A
ready may fail inspection.
Visually inspect battery terminals for cor- "fault" is a component or system that is not
rosion. Corrosion may indicate a loose ter- performing within an expected range. A fault How Can I Prepare for My Next OBD II
minal connector, or a battery near the end may be permanent or temporary. OBD II will Emission Inspection?
of its useful service life. Consult a trained store a message about any fault. If your Check Engine (MIL) light is lit or
and qualified Volvo service technician for was lit but went out without service, have
additional information.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

212
09 Maintenance and servicing

Maintaining your car 09

your vehicle diagnosed and, if necessary,


serviced by a qualified Volvo technician.
If you recently had service for a lit Check
Engine light, or if you had service that
required disconnecting the battery, a
period of driving is necessary to bring the
OBD II system to "ready" for inspection. A
half-hour trip of mixed stop-and-go/high-
way driving is typically needed to allow
OBD II to reach readiness. Your Volvo
retailer can provide you with more infor-
mation on planning a trip.
Maintain your vehicle in accordance with
your vehicle's maintenance schedule.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

213
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Hood

Opening the hood

G031032

To open the hood:


1. Pull the lever located under the left side of
the dash to release the hood lock.
2. Lift the hood slightly.
3. Press up the release control located under
the front edge of the hood (at the center)
up to the right, and lift the hood.

WARNING
Check that the hood locks engage properly
when closed.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

214
09 Maintenance and servicing

Engine compartment 09

G026456
Cooling system expansion tank Relay/fuse box
Power steering fluid reservoir (concealed Air cleaner
behind the headlight)
Dipstick engine oil WARNING
Radiator The cooling fan may start or continue to
operate (for up to 6 minutes) after the engine
Cooling fan has been switched off.
Washer fluid reservoir
Engine oil filler cap
Brake/clutch fluid reservoir
Battery

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

215
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Engine oil

Changing engine oil and oil filter


See page 269 for oil specifications. Refer to
the Warranty and Service Records Information
booklet for information on the oil change inter-
vals.
Volvo recommends Castrol.

NOTE
Volvo does not recommend the use of
oil additives.
Synthetic oil is not used when the oil is

G020338

G020336
changed at the normal maintenance
intervals except at owner request and at
additional charge. Please consult a Location of dipstick and oil filler cap
trained and qualified Volvo service tech- CAUTION
nician. Checking the oil
1. Pull out the dipstick and wipe it with a lint- Not checking the oil level regularly can
free rag. result in serious engine damage if the oil
Checking and adding oil level becomes too low.
The oil level should be checked every time the 2. Reinsert the dipstick, pull it out, and check
vehicle is refueled. This is especially important the oil level. Oil that is lower than the specified qual-
ity can damage the engine.
during the period up to the first scheduled 3. Add oil if necessary. If the level is close to
maintenance service the MIN mark, add approximately Always add oil of the same type and
viscosity as already used.
The car should be parked on a level surface 1 US quart (1 liter) of oil.
when the oil is checked. Never fill oil above the MAX mark. This
4. Run the engine until it reaches normal could cause an increase in oil consump-
If the engine is warm, wait for at least 10 operating temperature. tion.
15 minutes after the engine has been
5. Switch off the engine and wait for at least
switched off before checking the oil.
1015 minutes and recheck the oil level. If
necessary, add oil until the level is near the
MAX mark.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

216
09 Maintenance and servicing

Engine oil 09

WARNING
Do not allow oil to spill onto or come into
contact with hot exhaust pipe surfaces

NOTE
Volvo uses different systems to indicate a
low oil level or pressure. Some models have
an oil pressure sensor, in which case a
warning symbol (see page 57) is used to
indicate low oil pressure. Other models have
an oil level sensor, in which case the driver
is alerted by the warning symbol in the cen-
ter of the instrument panel and a text in the
information display. Some models use both
systems. Contact an authorized Volvo
retailer for more information.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

217
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Fluids

Washer fluid Coolant CAUTION


If necessary, top up the cooling system
with Volvo Genuine Coolant/Antifreeze
only (a 50/50 mix of water and anti-
freeze).
Different types of antifreeze/coolant
may not be mixed.
If the cooling system is drained, it
should be flushed with clean water or
premixed anti-freeze before it is refilled
with the correct mixture of water/anti-
G026425 freeze.

G020334
The cooling system must always be
kept filled to the correct level, and the
level must be between the MIN and
Washer fluid reservoir Coolant reservoir
MAX marks. If it is not kept filled, there
The washer fluid reservoir is located in the Normally, the coolant does not need to be can be high local temperatures in the
engine compartment and holds approximately changed. If the system must be drained, con- engine which could result in damage.
6.8 US qts (6.5 liters). During cold weather, the sult a trained and qualified Volvo service tech- Check coolant regularly!
reservoir should be filled with windshield nician. Do not top up with water only. This
washer solvent containing antifreeze. reduces the rust-protective and anti-
freeze qualities of the coolant and has a
lower boiling point. It can also cause
damage to the cooling system if it
should freeze.
Do not use chlorinated tap water in the
vehicles cooling system.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

218
09 Maintenance and servicing

Fluids 09

WARNING (280 C), P/N 9437433

Never remove the radiator cap while the Replace: The fluid should be replaced accord-
engine is warm. Wait until the vehicle cools. ing to the intervals specified in the Warranty
and Service Records Information booklet.
If it is necessary to top off the coolant when
the engine is warm, unscrew the expansion When driving under extremely hard conditions
tank cap slowly so that the overpressure (mountain driving, etc), it may be necessary to
dissipates. replace the fluid more often. Consult your
Volvo retailer. Always entrust brake fluid
changing to a trained and qualified Volvo serv-
Brake fluid ice technician.

Power steering fluid


The fluid level is checked at each service inter-
val.
Fluid type: Volvo power steering fluid or equiv-
alent.
Replace: No fluid change required.

WARNING
If a problem should occur in the power
G020333

steering system or if the vehicle has no elec-


trical current and must be towed, it is still
possible to steer the vehicle. However, keep
Brake fluid reservoir in mind that greater effort will be required to
turn the steering wheel.
The brake fluid should always be between the
MIN and MAX marks on the side of the reser-
voir. Check, without removing the cap, that
there is sufficient fluid in the reservoir.
Fluid type: DOT 4+ boiling point >536 F

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

219
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Wiper blades

Replacing windshield wiper blades Keeping the windshield wiper blades clean
helps improve visibility and prolongs the serv-
ice life of the wiper blades. See page 202 for
washing instructions.

G020330

1. Fold out the wiper arm.


2. Press the button on the wiper blade attach-
ment and pull straight out (1), parallel with
the wiper arm.
3. Press a new wiper blade (2) until it clicks
into place.
4. Ensure the blade is securely attached (3).
5. Fold in the wiper arm.
The wiper blades are different lengths. The
blade on the driver's side is longer than the one
on the passenger's side.

G020329

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

220
09 Maintenance and servicing

Battery 09

Battery maintenance WARNING Corrosive


Driving habits and conditions, climate, the
PROPOSITION 65 WARNING!
number of starts, etc., all affect the service life
and function of the battery. In order for your Battery posts, terminals, and related acces-
battery to perform satisfactorily, keep the fol- sories contain lead and lead compounds,
chemicals known to the state of California
lowing in mind:
to cause cancer and reproductive harm.
Check the fluid level in each cell in the battery Wash hands after handling. No smoking, no open flames,
every 24 months or every 15,0001 miles no sparks
(24,000 km), whichever is sooner.
Battery symbols:
Use a screw driver to open the caps or
Wear protection goggles
cover and a flashlight to inspect the level.
If necessary, add distilled water. The level
should never be above the indicator. Explosion
The fluid level should be checked if the
battery has been recharged.
After inspection, be sure the cap over each See owner's manual for
battery cell or the cover is securely in details
place.
Check that the battery cables are correctly
connected and properly tightened. Battery replacement
Never disconnect the battery when the Removing the battery
engine is running, or when the key is in the 1. Switch off the ignition and remove the key.
ignition. This could damage the vehicle's Keep away from children
electrical system. 2. Wait at least 5 minutes after switching off
the ignition before disconnecting the bat-
The battery should be disconnected from
tery so that all information in the vehicle's
the vehicle when a battery charger is used
directly on the battery. electrical system can be stored in the con-
trol modules.

1 More frequently in warm climates.


``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

221
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Battery

3. Remove the cover over the battery. WARNING


4. Disconnect the battery negative (ground) Never expose the battery to open flame
cable. or electric spark.
5. Disconnect the positive cable. Do not smoke near the battery.
6. Remove the front side of the battery box Battery fluid contains sulfuric acid. Do
with a screwdriver. not allow battery fluid to contact eyes,
skin, fabrics or painted surfaces. If con-
7. Release the clamp holding the battery. tact occurs, flush the affected area
8. Lift out the battery. immediately with water. Obtain medical
help immediately if eyes are affected.
Installing a new battery
1. Put the battery in place in the engine com-
partment.
2. Install the battery's retaining clamp.
3. Reinstall the front side of the battery box.
4. Connect the positive cable.
5. Connect the ground cable.
6. Reinstall the cover over the battery.

NOTE
Used batteries should be properly disposed
of at a recycling station or similar facility, or
taken to your Volvo retailer.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

222
09 Maintenance and servicing

Replacing bulbs 09

Introduction Removing the headlight housing light, turn signal, and side marker bulbs. To lift
Before replacing bulbs in your vehicle, please out the housing:
keep the following points in mind: WARNING 1. Remove the key from the ignition and turn
The engine should not be running when the headlight switch to position 0.
NOTE changing bulbs. 2. Open the hood.
Never touch the glass of bulbs with your fin- When changing in the headlight hous-
3. Pull up the headlight housing's retaining
gers. Grease and oils from your fingers ing, if the engine has been running just
vaporize in the heat and will leave a deposit pin.
prior to replacing bulbs, please be
on the reflector, which will damage it. aware that components in the engine 4. Pull out the headlight housing.
The optional Bi-Xenon headlight bulbs compartment will be hot.
contain trace amounts of mercury. These
bulbs should always be disposed of by a
trained and qualified Volvo service techni-
cian.
Certain bulbs should only be replaced by a
trained and qualified Volvo service techni-
cian:
Courtesylighting
Reading lights
Glove compartment lights
Turn signals and courtesy lights in the

G019600
side door mirrors

G019599
Brake lights
Bi-Xenon headlights, Brake lights 5. Disconnect the wiring connector by press-
ing down the clip with your thumb while at
The entire headlight housing must be lifted out the same time pulling the connector with
when replacing the high/low beam, parking your other hand.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

223
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Replacing bulbs

6. Lift out the headlight housing and place it Low beam bulb
on a soft surface to avoid scratching the
lens.

CAUTION
When disconnecting the connector, pull on
the connector itself and not on the wiring.

After the defective bulb has been replaced,


reinsert the housing in the reverse order. Check
that the retaining pin is correctly inserted.

G019133
G019131
WARNING
Bi-Xenon headlights (option) due to the Low beam bulb
high voltage used by these headlights, Cover with retaining clamps
these bulbs should only be replaced by a Installing a new bulb
trained and qualified Volvo service techni- 1. Open the hood and remove the headlight 1. Insert the new bulb. It can only be installed
cian. housing (see page 223 for instructions). in one position.
2. Release the retaining clamps on the cover. 2. Press the retaining spring inward and
3. Release the bulb's retaining spring holding upward and slightly to the right until it
the bulb in place by pressing it inward and snaps into place.
downward. 3. Press the wiring connector onto the bulb.

4. Pull out the bulb. 4. Put the plastic cover in place.


5. Press the retaining clamps back into place.
6. Reinstall the headlight housing (see
page 223).

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

224
09 Maintenance and servicing

Replacing bulbs 09

High beam bulb (halogen) WARNING Parking light bulb


Bi-Xenon headlights (option) due to the
high voltage used by these headlights, the
Bi-Xenon bulbs should only be replaced by
a trained and qualified Volvo service tech-
nician.

4. Driver's side headlight: Turn the bulb


holder counterclockwise.
Passenger's side headlight: Turn the bulb
holder clockwise.
5. Pull out the bulb holder and replace the
G019136

G019145
bulb.
6. Reinstall the bulb holder. It can only be
Halogen high beam bulb installed in one position. 1. Open the hood.
1. Open the hood.
7. Reinstall the cover on the upper side of the 2. Remove the headlight housing, see
2. Remove the headlight housing (see headlight housing by turning it clockwise. page 223.
page 223).
8. Reinstall the headlight housing (see 3. Remove the cover on the upper side of the
3. Remove the cover on the upper side of the page 223). headlight housing by turning it counter-
headlight housing by turning it counter- clockwise.
clockwise.
4. Pull out the bulb holder.
NOTE 5. Replace the bulb.
The halogen high beam bulb has a different 6. Press the bulb holder back into position. It
socket on vehicles equipped with Bi- will click into place.
Xenon headlights. On these models, pull
the bulb straight out. 7. Reinstall the cover on the upper side of the
headlight housing by turning it clockwise.
8. Reinstall the headlight housing.
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

225
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Replacing bulbs

Turn signal Side marker light Front fog light (option)

G019150

G018050

G017609
1. Open the hood. 1. Open the hood. 1. Switch off all lights and turn the key to
position 0.
2. Remove the headlight housing, see 2. Remove the headlight housing, see
page 223. page 223. 2. Remove the panel around the fog light
housing by inserting a screw driver as
3. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise and 3. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise,
shown in the illustration and pressing the
remove it. pull it out, and replace the bulb.
panel outward to release the retaining
4. Remove the bulb from the holder by press- 4. Reinstall the bulb holder. It can only be clips.
ing it in and twisting it counterclockwise. installed in one position.
3. Grasp the edge of the panel and pull it
5. Insert a new bulb and reinstall the bulb 5. Reinstall the headlight housing. straight out.
holder in the headlight housing.
4. Unscrew the screw in the fog light housing
6. Reinstall the headlight housing. and remove it.
5. Turn the bulb counterclockwise and
remove it.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

226
09 Maintenance and servicing

Replacing bulbs 09

6. Insert a new bulb by turning it clockwise 2. Remove the covers in the left/right panels Brake light (LED)1
(the profile on the bulb holder will corre- to access the bulb holders.
spond with the profile in the base of the Taillight
3. Disconnect the wiring connector from the
bulb). Parking light
affected bulb holder.
7. Reinsert the bulb holder. The mark TOP Fog light (driver's side only)
4. Press the catches together and pull out the
should be upward.
bulb holder.
Turn signal
5. Replace the defective bulb.
Removing the taillight bulb holder Back-up light
6. Press the bulb holder into place and rein-
stall the cover.
NOTE
Location of taillight bulbs If the message indicating a burned out bulb
remains in the information display after the
bulb has been replaced, consult a trained
and qualified Volvo service technician.

High-level brake light


These bulbs should only be replaced by a
trained and qualified Volvo service technician.
G020916

All bulbs in the taillight cluster can be replaced

G018055
from the trunk. To access the bulb holders:
1. Switch off all lights and turn the key to
position 0. Location of taillight bulbs

1 The wiring to the LED brake lights is permanently connected to the bulb holder. It should not be removed.
``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

227
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Replacing bulbs

License plate lighting Footwell lighting Trunk lighting

G014843

G020795

G020915
1. Switch off all lights and turn the key to The footwell lighting is located under the dash- 1. Insert a screwdriver and turn it gently to
position 0. board on the driver's and passenger's sides. detach the bulb housing.
To replace a bulb:
2. Remove the screws with a screw driver. 2. Remove the defective bulb.
1. Insert a screwdriver under the edge of the
3. Detach the entire bulb housing and care- 3. Install a new bulb.
lens. Turn the screwdriver gently to detach
fully pull it out. Turn the connector coun-
the lens. 4. Press the bulb housing back into place.
terclockwise and pull out the bulb.
2. Remove the defective bulb.
4. Replace the defective bulb.
3. Install a new bulb.
5. Reinstall the connector and turn it clock-
wise. 4. Press the lens back into place.
6. Reinstall the entire bulb housing and screw
it into place.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

228
09 Maintenance and servicing

Replacing bulbs 09

Vanity mirror lighting 6. Press the three lower lugs back into place.

G020253

1. Insert a screwdriver under the center of the


lower edge of the mirror, turn it, and care-
fully pry up the lugs at the edge.
2. Move the screwdriver under the edge on
the left and right-hand sides (near the black
rubber sections) and pry carefully to
release the lower edge of the mirror.
3. Pry carefully and lift out the entire mirror
and the cover.
4. Remove the defective bulb and replace it
with a new one.
5. To reinstall the mirror, begin by pressing
the three lugs at the upper edge of the mir-
ror back into place.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

229
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Fuses

Replacing fuses
There are relay/fuse boxes located in the
engine compartment and the passenger com-
partment.
If an electrical component fails to function, this
may be due to a blown fuse. The easiest way
to see if a fuse is blown is to remove it.
To do so:
1. Pull the fuse straight out. If a fuse is difficult
to remove, special fuse removal tools are
located on the inside of the fuse box cov-
ers.
2. From the side, examine the curved metal
wire in the fuse to see if it is intact.
3. If the wire is broken, insert a new fuse of
the same color and amperage (written on
the fuse).
If fuses burn out repeatedly, have the electrical
system inspected by a trained and qualified
Volvo service technician.

WARNING
Never use metal objects or fuses with higher
amperage than those stated on the follow-
ing pages. Doing so could seriously damage
or overload the vehicle's electrical system.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

230
09 Maintenance and servicing

Fuses 09

Fuse box in the engine compartment

G007446
The fuse box in the engine compartment has
positions for 36 fuses.
Fuses 118 are relays/circuit breakers and
should only be removed or replaced by an
authorized Volvo service technician.
Fuses 1936 may be changed at any time
when necessary.
Several extra fuses and a fuse removal tool to
assist in removing/replacing fuses can be
found on the underside of the fuse box cover
in the engine compartment.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

231
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Fuses

Fuses in the engine compartment

G020250
1. Coolant fan (radiator) 50A 9. Engine functions 30A 17. Windshield wipers 30A

2. Power steering 80A 10. Climate system blower 40A 18. Feed to passenger com- 40A
partment fuse box
3. Feed to passenger com- 60A 11. Headlight washers 20A
partment fuse box 19. Not in use
12. Feed to heated rear window 30A
4. Feed to passenger com- 60A 20. Horn 15A
partment fuse box 13. Starter motor relay 30A
21. Not in use
5. Element, climate unit 80A 14. Trailer connector (acces- 40A
sory) 22. Not in use
6. Not in use
15. Not in use 23. Engine control module 10A
7. ABS pump 30A (ECM)/transmission control
16. Feed to audio system 30A module (TCM)
8. ABS valves 20A

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

232
09 Maintenance and servicing

Fuses 09

24. Not in use

25. Not in use

26. Ignition switch 15A

27. A/C compressor 10A

28. Not in use

29. Front fog lights (option) 15A

30. Not in use

31. Not in use

32. Fuel injectors 10A

33. Heated oxygen sensor, vac- 20A


uum pump

34. Ignition coils, climate unit 10A


pressure sensor

35. Engine sensor valves, A/C 15A


relay, relay coil, PTC ele-
ment oil trap, canister, mass
air meter

36. Engine control module 10A


(ECM), throttle sensor

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

233
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Fuses

Fuse box in the passenger compartment

G020601
The fuse box in the passenger compartment is 6. Pull the center pins fully out of the mount-
located under the glove compartment. ing clips, secure the upholstery with the
mounting clips and press the pins into the
To access the fuses:
mounting clips again. The mounting clips
1. Remove the upholstery covering the fuse then expand, holding the upholstery in
box by first pressing in the center pins in position.
the mounting clips approximately 0.5 in
(1 cm) with a small screwdriver and then
pulling the pins out.
2. Turn both retaining screws (2) counter-
clockwise until they release.
3. Fold down the fuse box (3) half way. Pull it
toward the seat until it stops. Fold it down
completely. The fuse box can be unhooked
completely.
4. Replace the blown fuse.
5. Close the fuse box in reverse order.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

234
09 Maintenance and servicing

Fuses 09

Fuses in the passenger compartment

G020246
37. Not in use 44. Supplemental Restrain Sys- 10A 49. Supplemental Restrain Sys- 10A
tem (SRS), engine control tem (SRS), Occupant
38. Not in use module Weight Sensor (OWS)
39. Not in use 45. 12-volt socket in rear seat 15A 50. Not in use
40. Not in use 46. Lighting glove compart- 5A 51. AWD, fuel filter relay 10A
41. Not in use ment, instrument panel, and
footwells 52. Transmission control mod- 5A
42. Not in use ule (TCM), ABS
47. Interior lighting 5A
43. Audio system, Volvo Navi- 15A 53. Power steering 10A
gation system (option) 48. Windshield washers 15A
54. Park assist (option) Bi- 10A
Xenon headlights (option)

55. Not in use


``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

235
09 Maintenance and servicing

09 Fuses

56. Volvo Navigation System 10A 68. Cruise control 5A 83. Power window and door 25A
remote control module lock front driver's side
(option), alarm siren control 69. Climate system, rain sensor 5A door
module (option), BLIS button
(option) 84. Power passenger's seat 25A
57. On-board diagnostic 15A
socket, brake light switch 70. Not in use 85. Power driver's seat 25A

58. Right high beam, auxiliary 7.5A 71. Not in use 86. Interior lighting relay, trunk 5A
lights relay lighting, power seats
72. Not in use
59. Left high beam 7.5A 73. Moonroof, front ceiling 5A
60. Heated driver's seat 15A lighting, auto-dim mirror,
(option) (option) seat belt reminder

61. Heated passenger's seat 15A 74. Fuel pump relay 15A
(option) 75. Not in use
62. Moonroof (option) 20A 76. Not in use
63. Power window and door 20A 77. Auxiliary equipment control 15A
lock rear passenger's side module (AEM)
door
78. Not in use
64. Audio system, Volvo Navi- 5A
gation system (option) 79. Back-up lights 5A
65. Audio system 5A 80. Not in use
66. Audio system control mod- 10A 81. Power window and door 20A
ule (ICM), climate system lock rear driver's side door
67. Not in use 82. Power window front pas- 25A
senger's side door

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

236
09 Maintenance and servicing

09

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

237
Audio functions..................................................................................... 240
Radio functions..................................................................................... 244
CD player/CD changer.......................................................................... 249
Audio menu........................................................................................... 253

G020924
Bluetooth hands-free connection....................................................... 254

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

238
AUDIO

10
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
10 Audio

Audio functions

Audio system controls If the player is being charged through a 12-volt


socket while it is connect to the AUX port,
10 sound quality may be impaired.
The volume of the external sound source AUX
may be different from the volume of the internal
sound sources such as the CD player or the
radio. If the external sound source's volume is
too high, the quality of the sound may be
impaired.
This can be prevented by adjusting the external
sound source's input volume.

G021296
G026347
1. While playing the radio or a CD, lower the
audio volume to about one-quarter.
Auxiliary connector 2. Switch to AUX mode on the audio system
VOLUME dial Selecting a sound source by pressing the MODE button.

AM/FM select a radio band


Press AM/FM (2) repeatedly to toggle 3. Connect the headphone output from your
between FM1, FM2, and AM. music player to the AUX input using a cable
MODE select a sound source Press MODE (3) repeatedly to toggle with a stereo 3.5 mm miniplug at both
between the CD player and the optional ends.
TUNING dial
external sound source AUX or the optional 4. Set your music player's headphone vol-
SOUND button Sirius satellite radio.
ume to three-quarters using the player's
The currently selected sound source will be volume controls.
shown in the display.
5. Press MENU on the audio system, and
AUX navigate to AUX Volume or AUX Input
The AUX (auxiliary) port, located under the cen- Volume.
ter armrest, can be used to connect for exam- 6. Turn the volume knob to raise or lower the
ple, an mp3 player. AUX Input Volume until you hear music at
a comfortable level.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

240
10 Audio

Audio functions

7. If there is distortion, lower your music play- The four buttons on the steering wheel keypad An auxiliary device, such as an iPod, MP3
er's headphone volume until the distortion can be used to control the audio system. The player or a USB flash drive can be connected
goes away. steering wheel keypad can be used to adjust to the audio system via the connector in the 10
volume, shift between preset stations and center console storage compartment. A stand-
8. Finally, exit the menu and adjust the audio
change CD tracks. Press one of the two left- ard cable from an iPod or MP3 player can be
volume to a comfortable level.
hand buttons briefly to change to the next/ routed under the cover to the AUX connector
Volume previous preset radio station, or to go to the in the storage compartment.
Use the volume dial (1) or the buttons in the next/previous track on a CD. Press and hold
A sound source must be chosen, depending on
steering wheel keypad to adjust the volume down these buttons to search within a track on
the device that has been connected:
level. The volume level is also adjusted auto- a CD.
matically according to the vehicle's speed, see 1. Use MODE to select iPod or USB. The text
Daytime/twilight display CONNECT DEVICE will be displayed.
page 243 for more information on this func-
In daylight the information is displayed against
tion. 2. Connect the device to the connector in the
a light background. In darkness it is displayed
against a dark background. center console storage compartment (see
Steering wheel keypad the illustration).

USB/iPod connector (option) The text LOADING will be displayed while the
system loads the files (folder structure) on the
device. This may take a short time.
When information about the files (the folder
structure) on the device has been loaded, the
resulting list includes information on the artist,
genre and song title.
To navigate in the folder structure, press
ENTER and scroll up and down the folders
using the arrow buttons (on the audio system
G026424

control panel or on the steering wheel keypad).


Press the right arrow button to select a folder.
Press the left arrow button to go up a level in

G019823
Steering wheel keypad the folder structure. Press ENTER to go down
a level in the folder structure.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

241
10 Audio

Audio functions

iPod intended to enable the user to adapt sound


Tracks can be selected in two ways:
An iPod receives current and its battery is reproduction to his/her personal preferences.
10 Turn the Tuning knob (no. 4 in the illustra- charged through the connecting cord. How-
tion on page 244) clockwise or counter- 1. Press SOUND (5). Press this button
ever, if the iPod's battery is completely repeatedly until you come to the setting
clockwise drained, it should be recharged before the iPod that you wish to change.
Use the right or left arrow keys on the nav- is connected to the audio system.
igation control (no. 5 in the illustration on 2. Turn the TUNING dial (4) to make the
page 244) to select the desired track. The NOTE desired setting.
arrow keys on the steering wheel keypad
When an iPOD is used as a sound source, The following settings can be made:
can also be used in the same way.
the vehicle's audio system has a menu BASSset the bass level
structure similar to the one in the iPOD. See
NOTE the iPOD's manual for detailed information. TREBLEset the treble level
The system supports playback of files in the BALANCEset the left/right sound balance
most common versions of formats such as For further information, refer to the accessory
mp3, wma, and wav. However, there may be FADERset the front/rear sound balance
manual USB/iPod Music Interface.
versions of these formats that the system
does not support. SUBWOOFER (accessory)set the level for
Sound settings the subwoofer (bass speaker)

USB flash drive CENTERmake settings for the center speaker


Optimal sound reproduction
To simplify the use of a USB flash drive, it is SURROUNDmake settings for surround
The audio system is calibrated for optimal
advisable to only store music files on the drive. sound
sound reproduction through the use of digital
It will take considerably longer for the system
signal processing. This calibration takes into
to index the files on the drive if it contains any- Subwoofer (accessory)
account the speakers, amplifier, cabin acous-
thing other than compatible music files. To switch the subwoofer on or off:
tics, the seating position of the listener, etc., for
MP3 player each combination of vehicle and audio system. 1. Press MENU followed by ENTER.
Many mp3 players have a file indexing system There is also dynamic calibration that takes
2. Select AUDIO SETTINGS and press
that is not supported by the vehicle's audio into account the setting of the volume control,
ENTER.
system. In order to use an mp3 player, the sys- radio reception, and the vehicle's speed. The
sound settings described in this manual, such 3. Select SUBWOOFER and press ENTER.
tem must be set to USB Removable device/
Mass Storage Device. as BASS, TREBLE, and EQUALIZER are only

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

242
10 Audio

Audio functions

Surround sound 2. Select AUDIO SETTINGS in the menu and quencies can be selected with the Right/
Surround sound settings are used to press ENTER. Left arrows.
balance sound levels throughout the 10
3. Select Surround FM/AM/CD/AUX and Save the settings by pressing ENTER or
G021216

vehicle. Surround settings for the var- exit without saving by pressing EXIT.
press ENTER.
ious sound sources are made sepa-
rately. 4. Select Pro logic II, 3-channel stereo or Automatic sound control
Off and press ENTER. The audio system's volume is adjusted auto-
NOTE matically according to the speed of the vehicle.
Equalizer Front/Rear There are three settings available, which deter-
Dolby Surround Pro Logic II is only This function is used to fine-tune the sound mine the level of volume compensation:
available on the Premium Sound sys- level for different frequencies separately.
tem. Low
When listening to FM radio stations, NOTE Medium1
Dolby Surround Pro Logic II functions High
This function is only available on certain
best in areas with strong reception. If
sound systems. To set the automatic sound level:
reception is weak, selecting 2 or 3-
channel stereo may provide better 1. Press MENU followed by ENTER.
sound quality. To adjust the equalizer settings:
2. Select AUDIO SETTINGS in the menu and
1. Press MENU followed by ENTER. press ENTER.
The Dolby symbol will be appear in the display 2. Select AUDIO SETTINGS in the menu and
when Dolby Pro Logic II is activated. 3. Select AUTO. VOLUME CONTROL in the
press ENTER. menu and press ENTER.
There are three alternative settings:
3. Select Equalizer Front/Rear and press 4. Select Low, Medium, or High and press
Pro Logic II ENTER. ENTER.
3-channel The column in the display indicates the sound
Off (normal 2-channel stereo) level for the current frequency.

Activating/deactivating Surround sound Adjust the level with the TUNING dial (4),
1. Press MENU followed by ENTER. or use the Up/Down arrows. Additional fre-

1 Default setting.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

243
10 Audio

Radio functions

Radio function controls Searching for stations Automatically storing a station


There are two ways to manually tune a radio Pressing AUTO (7) automatically searches for
10 station: and stores up to ten strong AM or FM stations
in a separate memory. If more than ten stations
1. Turn the TUNING dial (3) to the desired fre-
are found, the ten strongest ones are stored.
quency.
This function is especially useful in areas in
2. Press the left or right arrow key on the which you are not familiar with radio stations or
MENU NAVIGATION CONTROL and their frequencies.
hold it down. The radio scans slowly in the
To use the AUTO function:
selected direction and will increase the
scanning speed after a few seconds. 1. Select a waveband using the AM/FM but-
Release the button when the desired fre- ton (1).
quency appears in the display.
G026366
2. Start the search by pressing AUTO until
The frequency can be fine-tuned by short AUTO STORING appears in the display.
presses on the left/right arrow keys.
When the search is completed, AUTO
1. AM/FM1/FM2 selection STORING will no longer be displayed. If there
2. Station preset buttons
Storing preset stations are no stations with sufficient signal strength,
NO AST FOUND is displayed.
3. TUNING dial for selecting radio stations Manually storing a station
1. Tune to the desired station. The auto-stored stations can be selected using
4. SCAN
the preset buttons (2).
5. MENU NAVIGATION CONTROLpress 2. Press and hold the preset button under
the up or down arrow keys to scroll in a which the station is to be stored. The audio Press EXIT (6) to terminate the automatic stor-
menu, or the keys on the left/right sides of system sound will be interrupted for a few ing function.
the control to search for or change radio seconds and STATION STORED will When the radio is in auto-store mode, AUTO is
stations/CD tracks appear in the display. shown in the display. AUTO disappears when
6. EXITpress to cancel a menu selection or you return to normal radio mode, which can be
a selected function NOTE done by briefly pressing AM/FM (1), EXIT (6),
A total of 30 stations can be stored; 10 sta- or AUTO (7).
7. AUTOsearch for and store the strongest
radio stations in the area in which you are tions each in AM, FM1 and FM2.
driving

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

244
10 Audio

Radio functions

To return to the Auto-store mode, press the 2. Press SCAN to activate the function. Listening to satellite radio
AUTO button briefly and select a stored station SCAN is shown in the display. The Sirius satellite system consists of a number
by pressing one of the preset buttons (2). 10
3. Press the SCAN or EXIT button to deacti- of high elevation satellites in geosynchronous
vate the scan function and listen to the orbit.
Saving auto-stored stations in the preset
memory selected station.
An auto-stored station can be saved in the
NOTE
Storing a station found with SCAN
memory for manually preset stations. A station can be stored as a preset while the The digital signals from the Sirius satel-
lites are line-of-sight, which means that
1. Press AUTO (7) briefly. SCAN function is activated.
physical obstructions such as bridges,
> Auto is displayed. Press one of the preset buttons (2) under tunnels, etc, may temporarily interfere
2. Press one of the preset buttons (2) under which the station is to be stored. Hold with signal reception.
down the button until STATION
which the station is to be stored. Hold Avoid any obstructions, such as metal-
down the button until STATION STORED is displayed. lic objects transported on roof racks or
STORED is displayed. The SCAN function will be deactivated and the in a ski box, or other antennas that may
station can be selected by pressing the preset impede signals from the SIRIUS satel-
The radio will then exit auto-store mode and button. lites.
the stored station can be selected by pressing
the preset button.
Radio text Selecting Sirius radio mode
Certain stations broadcast program informa- 1. Press Power to switch on the audio system
Scanning (see page 244 for information on the stand-
tion, which can be shown in the display.
SCAN (4) automatically searches through the ard radio functions).
selected waveband for strong AM or FM sta- To start this function:
tions. When the radio finds a station, that sta- 2. Press the MODE button repeatedly until
1. Select FM1 or FM2 and press the MENU Sirius 1 or 2 is displayed.
tion will be played for approximately 8 sec- button.
onds, after which scanning resumes. Activating Sirius radio
2. Press ENTER.
Activating/deactivating SCAN 1. Tune to a satellite channel that has no
3. Select RADIOTEXT in the menu and press audio, which means that the channel is
1. Select radio mode using the AM/FM but-
ENTER. unsubscribed and the text "Call 888-539-
ton (2).
To deactivate this function, select SIRIUS TO SUBSCRIBE" is displayed
RADIOTEXT again and press ENTER.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

245
10 Audio

Radio functions

(see also "Selecting a channel" in the right 5. Use the left or right arrow keys to select a 1. Press MENU and scroll to "Direct channel
column). channel in the currently chosen category. entry."
10
2. Call Sirius at 1-888-539-SIRIUS (7474). 6. Press ENTER to listen to a channel. 2. Use the numerical keypad to enter the
channel's number.
3. When asked for the Sirius ID number press
AUTO to display this number. It is also NOTE 3. Press ENTER. The radio will tune to this
possible to retrieve the Sirius ID from the The category "All" is default, which ena- channel, even if it belongs to a category
MENU. bles you to scroll through the entire list other than the currently selected one.
4. "UPDATING SUBSCRIPTION" will be of available satellite channels.
displayed while the subscription is being The channel categories are automati- NOTE
updated, after which the display will return cally updated several times a year. This The numbers of skipped or locked
to the normal view. takes approximately two minutes and channels will not be displayed.
will interrupt normal broadcasting. A
SIRUS ID message will be displayed while updat- If a channel is locked, the access code
ing is in progress. Information on chan- must be entered before the channel can
The SIRIUS ID is required when contacting the
nel or feature updates is available at be selected. See "Unlocking a channel"
Sirius Call Center. It is used to activate your on page 247.
account and when making any account trans- www.sirius.com.
actions. The SIRIUS ID is sometimes referred
to as the Electronic Serial Number (ESN). Selecting a channel Scanning
There are three ways of tuning in a channel:
Selecting a channel category NOTE
1. Select Sirius radio mode as described Using the left and right arrow keys
above. SCAN automatically searches through the
By turning the tuning control
list of satellite channels. see page 245 for
2. Press ENTER. Through direct channel entry more detailed information.
3. Use the up/down arrow keys to scroll Direct channel entry
through the list of categories. The Sirius satellite channels are numbered Storing a channel
4. Press ENTER or the right arrow key to consecutively throughout all of the categories. A long press on one of the number keys
To access a channel directly: stores the currently tuned channel on that
select a category.
key.
A short press on a number key while the
radio is in Sirius 1or 2 mode will tune to the

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

246
10 Audio

Radio functions

preset satellite channel stored on that but- Song seek Advanced settings
ton, regardless of the currently selected When a satellite radio channel plays one of the This menu function enables you to make set-
channel category. songs stored in the song memory, the listener 10
tings on certain Sirius satellite radio functions.
will be alerted by a text message and an audi- To access this menu:
Song Seek and Song Memory ble signal.
1. Press MENU.
The Song Seek and Song Memory functions Press ENTER to listen to the song or
provide both audio and visual notification when EXIT to cancel. 2. Scroll to Sirius menu.
Sirius is broadcasting your favorite songs. To activate/deactivate the song seek function: 3. Select Advanced Sirius settings.
Song Seek enables you to store the name of
the song for future advance notification when 1. Press MENU
WARNING
that song is being played. The Song Memory 2. Scroll to "Song seek"
feature makes it possible to view all of the cur- Settings should be made when the vehicle
rent songs that are stored in memory. 3. Press ENTER to activate or deactivate the is at a standstill.
function.
Song memory The following settings can be made in the Sir-
Up to ten songs can be saved in the system's NOTE ius menu.
memory.
When the song has ended, the radio will Songs can be added to the song list
1. Press MENU. remain tuned to the channel on which the
song was played. Channel skip settings can be made
2. Scroll to "Add song to song mem." and Channel lock settings can be made
follow the instructions shown in the dis-
play. Radio text The channel access code can be displayed
The text that is displayed about the song that or changed
If a new song is selected when the memory is is currently playing can be changed. Use the Your Sirius ID can be displayed
full, you will be prompted to press ENTER to AUTO button or the menu to display the Artist,
delete the last song on the list. Title, Composer, or switch radio text off. Skip options
This function is used to remove a channel from
NOTE the list of available channels.
The remaining songs in the list will move Skip current
down one position, and the newly added 1. Select CHANNEL SKIP LIST and press
song will be placed at the top of the list.
ENTER.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

247
10 Audio

Radio functions

2. Select a category in the list and press 2. Select CHANNEL LOCK LIST and press CHANGE CODE
ENTER. ENTER This function makes it possible to change the
10 channel access code. The default code is
3. Skip channels in the list presented by 3. Enter the channel access code and press
pressing ENTER or right arrow key. ENTER. 0000.

Unskip all channels 4. Select a category in the list and press To change the code:
ENTER. 1. Select CHANGE CODE and press
This permanently removes all channels from
the skip list and makes them available for 5. Lock channels in the list presented by ENTER.
selection. pressing ENTER or right arrow. 2. Enter the current code and press ENTER.
Temp. unskip all ch. The channel is now locked and a checked box 3. Enter the code and press ENTER.
This function will temporarily unskip all chan- will be displayed to indicate this. It will be nec-
4. Confirm the new code and press ENTER.
nels and make them available for selection. The essary to enter the channel access code1 in
order to listen to a locked channel. If an incorrect code is entered, the text
channels remain on the skip list and will again
be skipped the next time the ignition is Unlocking a channel: WRONG CODE! is displayed.
switched on. A channel's access code1 is required to unlock If you have forgotten the access code:
a channel.
Channel lock 1. Select "SIRIUS ID" in the Sirius settings
Unlock all channels menu and press ENTER.
Access to specific channels can be restricted
This permanently removes all channels from
(locked). A locked channel will not provide 2. Press and hold the ENTER button for
the locked list and makes them available for
audio, song titles, or artist information. 2 seconds.
selection.
Temp. unlock all ch. 3. The current code will be displayed.
NOTE
This function will temporarily unlock all chan- Your Volvo retailer can also provide you with
All channels are initially unlocked. nels and make them available for selection. The assistance.
channels remain on the locked list and will
Locking a channel again be locked the next time the ignition is SIRUS ID
1. Select "Sirius ID" in the menu and select switched on. This function displays the 12-digit Sirius acti-
LOCK OPTIONS and press ENTER. vation ID.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

248
10 Audio

CD player/CD changer

CD function controls Playing a CD NOTE


Single CD player Ensure that INSERT DISC is displayed 10
Start the CD player by pressing the MODE but- before inserting a disc.
ton (5) and inserting a disc in the slot (4). If there If a CD position in the changer contain-
is already a disc inserted, it will begin to play. ing a disc is selected, and the audio
system is in CD mode when it is
NOTE switched on, the CD will play automati-
cally.
If a CD is in the slot when the audio system
is in CD mode, the CD will be played auto-
matically. CD eject
Eject from Single CD player
CD changer Press the eject button (3) to eject the disc.
G026367

The CD changer can hold up to six discs. Eject from CD changer


1. Start the CD changer by pressing the This function makes it possible to eject a single
MENU NAVIGATION CONTROLpress MODE button (5). disc, or to eject all of the discs in the changer.
the up or down arrow keys to scroll in a
menu, or the keys on the left/right sides of
2. Select an empty position using the 1 6 Press the eject button (3) briefly to eject the
buttons or the up/down keys on the MENU disc that is currently playing.
the control to change CD tracks/fast for-
NAVIGATION CONTROL. The display A longer press (more than two seconds)
ward/back
shows which positions are empty. starts the process of ejecting all of the
Buttons for selecting a disc in the discs in the changer.
3. Insert a disc into the slot (4).
optional CD changer
CD eject button
CD slot
MODE button
TUNING dial for selecting tracks

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

249
10 Audio

CD player/CD changer

NOTE time that this takes depends on the quality of NOTE


the disc.
10 The EJECT ALL function can only be The TUNING dial (6) (turn clockwise to go to
used while the vehicle is at a standstill Navigating the disc and playing tracks the next track/file, or counterclockwise to
and will be cancelled if the vehicle If a disc with audio files is in the CD player, go to the previous track/file) or the steering
begins to move. press ENTER to display a list of folders on the wheel keypad can also be used for this pur-
pose.
For reasons of traffic safety, the ejected disc.
CD must be removed within 12 seconds Use the up and down arrows in the navigation
or it will be automatically drawn back Fast forward/back
control (see the illustration on page 249) to
into the slot and the CD player will enter Press and hold down the left or right arrows
move among the folders on the disc. Audio files
pause mode. Press the CD button to keys in the MENU NAVIGATION CONTROL (or
restart the disc. have the symbol and folders containing the corresponding keys on the optional steer-
these files have the symbol. Press ing wheel keypad) to search within a track/file
ENTER to play a selected folder or a file. or the whole disc. The search continues for as
CD Pause
When the music file has been played, the long as the buttons are held down.
When the audio system volume is turned off
completely, the CD player will pause and will player will continue to play the rest of the files Random play
resume playing when the volume is turned up in the current folder. When all of the files in the This function plays the tracks/files on a CD (or
again. folder have been played, the player will auto- on all of the CDs if the vehicle is equipped with
matically go to the next folder and play the files the optional CD changer) in random order
Audio files in it. (shuffle).
In addition to playing normal music CDs, the
CD player/changer can also play discs con- Press the left or right arrow key on the naviga-
tion control if the entire name of the current Activating/deactivating the random
taining files in mp3 or wma format. function-CD player
track does not fit in the display.
NOTE If a normal CD is being played:
Changing tracks 1. Press MENU followed by ENTER.
Certain discs that are copy protected can- Briefly press the left or right arrow keys on the
not be read by the player. MENU NAVIGATION CONTROL to skip to the 2. Select Random and press ENTER.
previous or next track/file. If a CD with audio files is being played:
When a disc with audio files is inserted in the 1. Press MENU followed by ENTER.
player, the player scans the disc's folders 2. Select Random and press ENTER.
before it begins playing the files. The length of

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

250
10 Audio

CD player/CD changer

3. Select Disc or Folder and press ENTER. 1. Press MENU. Select the menu for relevant NOTE
sound source and press ENTER.
Activating/deactivating the random The Eject all function can only be used 10
function-CD changer 2. Select Disc text in the menu and press while the vehicle is at a standstill and will
ENTER. be cancelled if the vehicle begins to
If a normal CD is being played: move.
> If information is stored on the disc, it will
1. Press MENU followed by ENTER.
now appear in the display. For reasons of traffic safety, the ejected
2. Select Random and press ENTER. CD must be removed within 12 seconds
To deactivate this function, select Disc text in
3. Select Single disc or All discs and press the menu and press ENTER. or it will be automatically drawn back
into the slot and the CD player will enter
ENTER.
Scan pause mode. Press the CD button to
If a CD with audio files is being played: This function plays the first 10 seconds of each restart the disc.
1. Press MENU followed by ENTER. track/file on the CD.
2. Select Random and press ENTER. Press SCAN. Compact disc care
3. Select Single disc or Folder and press Press EXIT or SCAN to stop the scan func- Keep the following in mind when playing/han-
ENTER. tion and listen to an entire track/file. dling compact discs

NOTE CD eject Do not put tape or labels on the disc itself.


They could become stuck in the player.
Single CD player
CD changer onlyyou can only select the Press the eject button (3) to eject the disc. CDR discs can cause listening problems
next random track/file on the current disc. due to the quality of the disc or recording
CD changer equipment used.
This function makes it possible to eject a single
Press the EXIT button to stop random play. disc, or to eject all of the discs in the changer.
DualDisc: The audio side of a DualDisc
The random function is automatically deacti- (combined CD/DVD) does not meet CD
vated when another disc is selected. Press the eject button (3) briefly to eject the specifications and may not play in your
disc that is currently playing. audio system.
Disc text (CD changer only) A longer press (more than two seconds) Keep the discs clean. Wipe them with a
Certain CDs contain information about the starts the process of ejecting all of the soft, clean, lint-free cloth, working from the
disc, such as the titles of the tracks, etc. This discs in the changer. center outward. If necessary, dampen the
information can be shown in the display by cloth with a neutral soap solution. Dry thor-
activating the DISC TEXT function. oughly before using.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

251
10 Audio

CD player/CD changer

Never use cleaning spray or antistatic liq-


uid. Use only cleaners specifically made for
10 CDs.
Use discs of the correct size only (3.5"
discs should never be used).
Volvo does not recommend the use of
plastic outer rings on the disc.
Condensation may occur on discs/optical
components of the changer in cold winter
weather. The disc can be dried with a
clean, lint-free cloth. Optical components
in the CD changer may, however, take up
to one hour to dry off.
Never attempt to play a damaged CD.
When not in use, the discs should be
stored in their covers. Avoid storing discs
in excessive heat, direct sunlight or in
dusty locations.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

252
10 Audio

Audio menu

FM1/FM2 menu
1. RADIOTEXT ON/OFF
10
2. ADVANCED RADIO SETTINGS
3. AUDIO SETTINGS

AM menu
1. AUDIO SETTINGS

CD menu
1. RANDOM
2. AUDIO SETTINGS

CD changer menu
1. RANDOM
2. DISC TEXT ON/OFF
3. AUDIO SETTINGS

AUX menu
1. AUX VOLUME
2. SOUND SETTINGS

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

253
10 Audio

Bluetooth hands-free connection

Introduction and other controls on the cell phone can The symbol indicates that the hands-free
always be used regardless of whether or not system is active.
10 the phone is connected to the hands-free sys-
tem. A long press on the PHONE button deactivates
the hands-free system and disconnects the
cell phone.
NOTE
Not all cell phones are fully compatible with Connecting cell phones
the hands-free system. A list of compatible The procedure for connecting a cell phone var-
phones is available at your Volvo retailer or ies, depending on the phone itself, and on
at www.volvocars.com whether or not the phone has been previously
connected.
WARNING If this is the first time the phone is to be con-
nected to the hands-free system, proceed as
G029503

Never use the hands-free feature or any


other device in your vehicle in a way that follows:
distracts you from the task of driving safely. Alternative 1using the vehicle's menus
System overview Distraction can lead to a serious accident.
Cell phone 1. Activate the cell phones Bluetooth func-
tion (refer to the phones owners manual if
Location of the microphone Getting started necessary) or go to www.volvocars.com
Center console control panel and display Use the controls in the center console (3) to 2. Activate the vehicles Bluetooth hands-
access, navigate and make selections in the free system by briefly pressing the
Bluetooth hands-free hands-free systems menus (see page 258). PHONE button.
This option makes it possible to set up a wire- > Add phone will be displayed. If one or
Activating/deactivating
less connection between a Bluetooth-enabled more cell phones are already registered
A short press on the PHONE button in the cen-
cell phone and the vehicles audio system. This in the system, they will also be dis-
ter console activates the hands-free system.
enables the audio system to function as a played.
The text TELEPHONE will appear at the top of
hands-free connection and allows you to
the display to indicate that the audio system is 3. Select Add phone.
remote-control a number of the phones func-
in telephone mode.
tions. The microphone used by this system is
located in the ceiling console (2). The buttons

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

254
10 Audio

Bluetooth hands-free connection

> The audio system will search for cell The cell phone will be registered and will be the drivers door is opened on vehicles equip-
phones that are in range. This search connected automatically to the audio system ped with the optional keyless drive).
takes approximately 30 seconds. Any while the text Synchronising is displayed. For 10
When the cell phone is disconnected from the
phones detected will be displayed with more information on synchronizing a cell
hands-free system, a call in progress can be
their Bluetooth names. The hands-free phone, see page 257.
continued using the cell phones own speaker
systems Bluetooth name will appear and microphone.
When a connection has been established, the
in the cell phones display as My Car.
symbol and the cell phones Bluetooth
4. Select one of the cell phones shown in the name will be displayed. The cell phone can NOTE
audio systems (center console) display. now be controlled from the audio system. Certain cell phones may require confirma-
5. Using the cell phones keypad, enter the tion from the phones keypad when a call is
Making a call transferred from hands-free to the cell
digits shown in the audio systems display.
1. Ensure that TELEPHONE is shown at the phone.
Alternative 2using the cell phones menus top of the center console display and that
1. Activate the hands-free system by briefly the symbol is visible (by pressing briefly
pressing the PHONE button in the center on PHONE on the center console). Handling calls
console. If there is a cell phone connected, 2. Dial the desired phone number or use the Incoming calls
disconnect it from the hands-free system phone book (see page 257). Press ENTER to answer a call, even if the audio
(by pressing PHONE in the center console
3. Press ENTER. system is currently in e.g., CD or FM mode.
for several seconds).
Press EXIT to defer a call.
2. Perform a search using the cell phones End the call by pressing EXIT.
Bluetooth function (consult the cell Automatic answer
Disconnecting the cell phone This function means that incoming calls will be
phones owners manual if necessary).
The cell phone is automatically disconnected answered automatically. Activate or deactivate
3. Select My Car in the list of devices shown from the audio system if it is moved out of the function in the menu system under Phone
in the cell phones display. range. For more information about connec- settings Call options Automatic
tions, see page 254.
4. When prompted, enter the PIN code 1234 answer.
in the cell phone. The cell phone can be manually disconnected
from the hands-free system by pressing
5. Connect to My Car from the cell phone.
PHONE. The hands-free system is also deac-
tivated when the ignition is switched off (or if

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

255
10 Audio

Bluetooth hands-free connection

Call settings Sound settings Sounds and volume Ring signal Ring
While a call is in progress, press MENU or signal 1,2,3....
10 ENTER on the center console to access the Call volume
following functions: Call volume can be adjusted when the hands-
free system is activated. Use the buttons in the
NOTE
Microphone offmute the audio systems steering wheel keypad or the audio systems The connected cell phones ring tone is not
microphone. volume control. switched off when one of the hands-free
Transfer call to mobiletransfer the call system's ringing tones is used.
from hands-free to the cell phone. Audio system volume
While a phone call is in progress, volume for If you prefer to use the connected cell phones
Phone bookthis feature enables you to the audio system can be adjusted in the normal
search for a stored telephone number. ring tone1, go to Phone settings Sounds
way with the audio system's volume control. In
order to adjust volume during a phone call, the and volume Ring signal Use mobile
NOTE audio system must be switched to one of the phone signal
On certain cell phones, the connection other modes (FM, CD, etc).
is broken when the mute function is More information about registering
Audio system sound can be automatically
used, which is normal. If this happens, and connecting cell phones
muted when a phone call is received in Phone
the hands-free system will prompt you
settings Sounds and volume Mute A maximum of 5 cell phones can be registered
to reconnect.
radio and adjust the volume with the / in the hands-free system. Registration only
A new call cannot be initiated while needs to be done once for each phone. After
another call is in progress. keys on the center console.
registration, the cell phone no longer needs to
Ringing volume be in sight or searchable. Only one cell phone
Go to Phone settings Sounds and volume can be connected to hands-free at a time.
Phones can be unregistered in Bluetooth
Ring volume and adjust the volume with
Remove telephone
the / keys on the center console.
Automatic connection
Ringing tones When the hands-free system is active and the
The hands-free systems integrated ringing most recently connected cell phone is within
tones can be selected in Phone settings range, it is detected automatically. When the

1 Not supported by all cell phones

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

256
10 Audio

Bluetooth hands-free connection

audio system searches for the most recently made in the phone book of the currently con- Voice control
connected phone, this phones name appears nected cell phone. If the cell phone that is currently connected
in the display. To manually connect a different allows calls to be made via voice commands, 10
cell phone, press EXIT. NOTE this function can be used by pressing and hold-
ing ENTER.
Manual connection If a particular cell phone does not support
To connect a phone other than the one that copying of the phone book, List is empty Voice mail number
was most recently connected or to switch will be displayed when copying has been
completed.
The phone number to your voice mail can be
between cell phones that are already regis- changed in the menu Phone settings Call
tered in the hands-free system: options Voice mail number. If no number
If the phone book contains information about
1. Put the audio system in telephone mode. someone who is trying to call you, this infor- has been stored, this menu can be accessed
2. Press PHONE in the center console and mation will be shown in the display. by a prolonged press on button 1. Once a
select one of the phones on the list. phone number has been stored, press and hold
Searching for contacts 1 to dial this number.
A connection can also be established in the
The easiest way to search for a contact in the
menu system under Bluetooth Connect Call lists
phone book is to press and hold any of the
phone or Change phone. Lists of calls in a particular cell phone are cop-
buttons 29. This starts a search based on the
first letter on the button that has been pressed. ied to the hands-free system each time that
Phone book phone is connected. These lists are then upda-
The phone book can also be accessed by ted while the phone is connected. Press
In order to use the hands-free systems phone pressing the navigation buttons / on the ENTER to show the most recently dialed num-
book (list of contacts), TELEPHONE must be
center console or by pressing / on the bers. Other call lists can be found under Call
displayed at the top of the center console dis-
steering wheel keypad. A search can also be register.
play and the symbol must be visible.
made in the phone books search menu in
The audio system stores a copy of the phone Phone book Search: NOTE
book of each registered cell phone. The phone
1. Enter the first letter of the contacts name Certain cell phones display the list of the
book is automatically copied each time a most recently dialed numbers in reverse
phone is connected. This function can be acti- and press ENTER or simply press ENTER.
order.
vated in Phone settings Synchronise 2. Select the desired contact and press
phone book. Searches for contacts are only ENTER to make a call to that person.

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

257
10 Audio

Bluetooth hands-free connection

Entering text Button Function 5.4. Connect fr. mobile phone


Text is entered by using the number buttons in 6. Phone settings
10 the center console. Press a button once to TUV8
enter the first letter on the button, twice to enter 6.1. Call options
the second letter, etc. Continue to press the WXYZ9 6.1.2. Automatic answer
button to display other characters.
6.1.3. Voice mail number
Press EXIT briefly to erase a character. Press Press briefly if two characters are
and hold EXIT to erase all of the characters that 6.2. Sounds and volume
to be entered in succession from
have been entered. Use the / buttons on the same button. 6.3. IDIS
the center console to navigate among the char- 6.4. Synchronize phone book
acters. +0@*#&$/%

Button Function Shift between uppercase and


lowercase letters
Space .1-? ! , : " ' ( )

Bluetooth menus
ABC2
1. Missed calls
DEF3 2. Received calls
3 Dialed calls
GHI4 4. Phone book
4.1. Search
JKL5
4.2. Copy fr. mobile phone
MNO6 5. Bluetooth...
5.1. Change phone
PQRS7
5.2. Connect phone
5.3. Disconnect phone

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

258
10 Audio

10

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

259
Label information.................................................................................. 262
Dimensions and weights....................................................................... 264
Fuel, oils, and fluids.............................................................................. 267
Engine oil............................................................................................... 269
Engine specifications............................................................................ 270
Electrical system................................................................................... 272
Three-way catalytic converter............................................................... 274

G000000
Volvo programs..................................................................................... 275

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

260
SPECIFICATIONS

11
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
11 Specifications

Label information

11

G026483
G032544
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

262
11 Specifications

Label information

Model plate tification label on the underside of the hood.


Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). Codes for For further information regarding these regula-
color and upholstery, etc. tions, please consult your Volvo retailer.

Federal Motor Vehicle Safety


Standards (FMVSS) specifications (USA)
and Ministry of Transport (CMVSS) 11
standards (Canada)
Your Volvo is designed to meet all applicable
safety standards, as evidenced by the certifi-
cation label on the facing side of the driver's
door. For further information regarding these
regulations, please consult your Volvo retailer.

Loads and Tire Pressures


The appearance of the decal will vary, depend-
ing on the market for which the vehicle is
intended.
Canadian models have the upper decal
U.S. models have the lower decal.

Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)1


The VIN plate is located on the top left surface
of the dashboard. The VIN is also stamped on
the right hand door pillar.

Vehicle Emission Control Information


Your Volvo is designed to meet all applicable
emission standards, as evidenced by the cer-

1 The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) should always be quoted in correspondence concerning your vehicle with the retailer and when ordering parts.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

263
11 Specifications

Dimensions and weights

Dimensions

11

G017401
Position Dimension in. (mm)
A Wheelbase 103.9 in. (264 cm)

B Length 175.9 in. (447 cm)

C Load length, floor, seatback down 68.7 in. (175 cm)

D Load length, floor 38.4 in. (98 cm)

E Height 57.2 in. (145 cm)

F Track, front 60.4 in. (154 cm)

G Track, rear 60.3 in. (153 cm)

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

264
11 Specifications

Dimensions and weights

Position Dimension in. (mm)


H Width 69.7 in. (177 cm)

I Width encl. door mirrors 79.6 in. (202 cm)

Weights 11

Category USA Canada


Gross vehicle weight FWDA: 4320 lbs lbs 1960 kg
FWD Turbo: 4320 lbs 1960 kg
AWDB Turbo: 4450 lbs 2020 kg

Capacity weight FWD: 800 lbs 365 kg


AWD: 800 lbs 365 kg

Permissible axle weight, front FWD: 2380 lbs 1080 kg


FWD Turbo: 2380 lbs 1080 kg
AWD Turbo: 2420 lbs 1100 kg

Permissible axle weight, rear FWD: 2130 lbs 970 kg


FWD Turbo: 2130 lbs 970 kg
AWD Turbo: 2220 lbs 1000 kg

Curb weight FWD: 31653300 lbs 14351505 kg


AWD: 34153455 lbs 15551575 kg

Max. roof load All models: 165 lbs All models: 75 kg

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

265
11 Specifications

Dimensions and weights

Category USA Canada


Max. trailer weight (w/o brakes)C All models: 1540 lbs All models: 700 kg

Max. trailer weight (with brakes) All models: 2000 lbs All models: 900 kg

Max. tongue weight All models: 165 lbs All models: 75 kg


11
A FWD = Front Wheel Drive
B AWD = All Wheel Drive
C Models equipped with the B5244S7 engine (engine code 39, which is the 6th and 7th digits from the left in your vehicle's VIN number, see chapter Label information, for the location of the VIN plate),
may not be used to tow trailers or vehicles of any kind. This could cause damage to the vehicle's emission control systems.

CAUTION
The maximum permissible axle loads and/
or the gross vehicle weight must not be
exceeded.

WARNING
When adding accessories, equipment, lug-
gage and other cargo to your vehicle, the
total capacity weight must not be exceeded.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

266
11 Specifications

Fuel, oils, and fluids

Specifications and capacities


Category Specification Capacity
Fuel tank Octane rating: unleaded gasoline, minimum 15.9 US gallons (60 liters)
octane requirement AKI 87, recommended rat-
Models with All Wheel Drive have a tank volume
ing AKI 91 or above.
of 15 US gallons (57 liters). 11
Models with engine code 39 have a fuel tank
capacity of 14 US gallons (53 liters). This code
is the 6th and 7th digits from the left in your
vehicle's VIN number. see page 262 for the
location of the VIN plate.

Engine oil (with filter replacement) See page 269 for information on engine oil 6.1 US quarts (5.8 liters)
specifications.

Automatic transmission oil Non-turbo engine: JWS 3309 8.19 US quarts (7.75 liters)

Manual transmission oil BOT 130 5-speed: 2.2 US quarts (2.1 liters)
6-speed: 2.1 US quarts (2.0 liters) turbo mod-
els

Coolant Volvo original coolant/antifreeze (50/50 mixture 10.5 US quarts (10 liters) models with auto-
of water and anti-freeze) matic transmission
10 US quarts (9.5 liters) models with manual
transmission

Brake fluid DOT 4+ boiling point >536 F (280 C), P/N 0.63 US quarts (0.6 liters)
9437433

Power steering fluid WSS M2C204-A or equivalent 1.3 US quarts (1.2 liters) system and reservoir
combined

``
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

267
11 Specifications

Fuel, oils, and fluids

Category Specification Capacity


Washer fluid reservoir Use washer fluid solvent in cold weather con- 6.8 US quarts (6.5 liters)
ditions.

Air conditioning system Refrigerant R134a 1.2 lbs. (530 grams)


11
NOTE
The transmission oil does not normally need
to be changed during the service life of the
vehicle. However, it may be necessary to
replace the oil if the vehicle is often driven
in areas of sustained temperature extremes
(hot or cold), when towing a trailer over long
distances, for prolonged driving in moun-
tainous areas, or if the vehicle is often driven
short distances in temperatures under 40 F
(5 C).

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

268
11 Specifications

Engine oil

Oil specifications Oil viscosity (stable ambient recommended for driving in areas of sustained
Engine oil must meet the minimum ILSAC temperatures) temperature extremes (hot or cold), when tow-
specification GF-4, API SL, or ACEA A1/B1. ing a trailer over long distances, and for pro-
Lower quality oils may not offer the same fuel longed driving in mountainous areas.
economy, engine performance, or engine pro-
American Petroleum Institute (API)
tection.
symbol 11
Volume: 6.1 US qts (5.8 liters).
Volume between the MIN and Max marks on
the dipstick: approximately 1.4 US qts (1.3 lit-
ers).
Volvo recommends Castrol.

G023491
Depending on your driving habits, premium or
synthetic oils may provide superior fuel econ-
omy and engine protection. Consult your Volvo Operation in hot climates
retailer or a trained and qualified Volvo service When temperatures exceed 104 F (40 C) in

G022917
technician for recommendations on premium your area, Volvo recommends, for the protec-
or synthetic oils. tion of your engine, that you use a heavier
Oil additives must not be used. weight oil, such as such as SAE 5W-40 or The API Service Symbol "donut" is divided into
0W-40. See the viscosity chart. three parts:
NOTE Operation in temperate climates The upper section describes the oil's per-
Synthetic oil is not used when the oil is Incorrect viscosity oil can shorten engine life. formance level.
changed at the normal service intervals. Under normal use when temperatures do not The center identifies the oil's viscosity.
This oil is only used at customer request, at exceed 104 F (40 C), SAE 5W-30 will provide
additional charge. Please consult a trained The lower section indicates whether the oil
good fuel economy and engine protection. See has demonstrated energy-conserving
and qualified Volvo service technician.
the viscosity chart. properties in a standard test in comparison
to a reference oil.
Extreme engine operation
Synthetic oils meeting SAE 0W-30 or 0W-40
and complying with oil quality requirements are

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

269
11 Specifications

Engine specifications

Engine designation B5244S4 B5244S7A B5254T7


OutputB

kW/rps 125/100 123/100 169/83

hp/rpm 168/6000 165/6000 227/5000


11
Torque

Nm/rps 230/73 230/73 320/25-80

ft. lbs./rpm 170/4400 170/4400 236/1500-4800

No. of cylinders 5 5 5

Displacement (liters/cubic inches) 2.44/148.6 2.44/148.6 2.52/153.8

Bore (mm/in.) 83/3.27 83/3.27 83/3.27

Stroke (mm/in.) 90/3.54 90/3.54 93.2/3.67

Compression ratio 10.3:1 10.3:1 9.0:1

Spark plugs

type Volvo kit no. 30650843 Volvo kit no. 30650843 Volvo kit no. 30650379

gap inches/mm (3x) 0.024 0.004 in./0.6 (3x) 0.024 0.004 in./0.6 0.027in./0.7mm
0.1mm 0.1mm

tightening torque ft. lbs./Nm 22.5 ft. lbs./30 Nm 22.5 ft. lbs./30 Nm 22.5 ft. lbs./30 Nm
A Certain markets
B The engine specifications for horsepower and torque listed in this table are based on the use of premium fuel.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

270
11 Specifications

Engine specifications

Charge air cooler (Intercooler)


Turbocharged engines employ a turbo-com-
pressor to force air into the engine inlet mani-
fold and a charge air cooler to cool the
compressed inlet air. The resulting increase in
air flow raises pressure in the intake manifold
and increases engine power over that devel- 11
oped by the normally-aspirated engine. The
charge air cooler (which resembles a radiator)
is located between the turbo-compressor and
inlet manifold.

Fuel system
The engine is equipped with a multiport fuel
injection system.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

271
11 Specifications

Electrical system

General information If the battery must be replaced, replace it with


12-volt system with voltage controlled gener- one with the same cold start capacity and
ator. Single wire system in which the chassis reserve capacity as the original (see the decal
and engine block are used as conductors, on the battery).
grounded on the chassis.
WARNING
11
Battery PROPOSITION 65 WARNING!

Voltage 12 V 12 V Battery posts, terminals, and related acces-


sories contain lead and lead compounds,
Cold start 600 AA 700 AB chemicals known to the state of California
capacity to cause cancer and reproductive harm.
Wash hands after handling.
(CCA)

Reserve 120 min 135 min


capacity
(RC)

Capacity 70 80
(Ah)
A Models equipped with the High Performance audio system
B Models equipped with the Premium Sound audio system,
the Volvo Navigation System and/or keyless drive

Bulbs used in the car


Bulb Output Type
Low beam headlight 55W H7

High beam headlight (applies to vehicles with halogen headlights) 55W H9

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

272
11 Specifications

Electrical system

Bulb Output Type


Extra high beam (models with Active Bi-Xenon headlights only) 55W H7

Brake light, back-up light, rear fog light 21W P21W

Turn signal, front/rear (applies to models with halogen headlights) 21W PY21W
11
Turn signal, front/rear (models with Active Bi-Xenon headlights) 24W P21/5W

Rear parking light, side marker light 5W P21/W5

Footwell lighting, cargo compartment light, license plate lighting 5W C5W

Vanity mirror 1.2W Festoon

Front parking light, side turn signal 5W W5W

Front fog light (option) 35W H8

Glove compartment light 3W Festoon

NOTE
For information regarding any other bulbs
not mentioned in this section, please con-
tact your Volvo retailer or a trained and
authorized Volvo service technician.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

273
11 Specifications

Three-way catalytic converter

Three-way catalytic converter NOTE


general information
Unleaded fuel is required for vehicles with
Keep your engine properly tuned. Certain three-way catalytic converters.
engine malfunctions, particularly involving
the electrical, fuel or distributor ignition
systems, may cause unusually high three-
11 way catalytic converter temperatures. Do
not continue to operate your vehicle if you
detect engine misfire, noticeable loss of
power or other unusual operating condi-
tions, such as engine overheating or back-
firing. A properly tuned engine will help
avoid malfunctions that could damage the
three-way catalytic converter.
Do not park your vehicle over combustible
materials, such as grass or leaves, which
can come into contact with the hot exhaust
system and cause such materials to ignite
under certain wind and weather condi-
tions.
Excessive starter cranking (in excess of
one minute), or an intermittently firing or
flooded engine can cause three-way cata-
lytic converter or exhaust system over-
heating.
Remember that tampering or unauthorized
modifications to the engine, the Electronic
Control Module, or the vehicle may be ille-
gal and can cause three-way catalytic con-
verter or exhaust system overheating. This
includes:

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

274
11 Specifications

Volvo programs

Volvo On Call Roadside Assistance


Your new Volvo comes with a four year ON
CALL roadside assistance. Additional informa-
tion, features, and benefits are described in a
separate information package in your glove
compartment.
11
If you require assistance, dial:
American customers: 1-800-638-6586
(1-800-63-VOLVO)
Canadian customers: 1-800-263-0475

Technician certification
In addition to Volvo factory training, Volvo sup-
ports certification by the National Institute for
Automotive Service Excellence (A.S.E.). Certi-
fied technicians have demonstrated a high
degree of competence in specific areas.
Besides passing exams, each technician must
also have worked in the field for two or more
years before a certificate is issued. These pro-
fessional technicians are best able to analyze
vehicle problems and perform the necessary
maintenance procedures to keep your Volvo at
peak operating condition.

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

275
12 Index

1, 2, 3 ... Audio system AUX port.................................................. 240


audio functions................................... 240 Axle weight...................................... 183, 265
12-volt sockets.......................................... 62 automatic sound control..................... 243
AUX port............................................. 240
CD changer......................................... 249
CD player/changer.............................. 249 B
A compact disc care.............................. 251 Backrest, rear seat, folding...................... 113
A/C (air conditioning)................................. 92 Dolby Surround Pro Logic II............... 243
Bass......................................................... 242
ABS (anti-lock brake system).................. 153 equalizer............................................. 243
menu settings..................................... 253 Battery
12 Active Bi-Xenon headlights........................ 63
radio functions.................................... 244 maintenance....................................... 221
Airbags selecting a sound source.................... 240 remote control, replacing................... 120
front...................................................... 22 Sirius satellite radio............................ 245 specifications...................................... 272
inflatable curtain................................... 30 sound settings.................................... 242 warning symbols................................. 221
side impact........................................... 29 steering wheel keypad........................ 241 Battery replacing................................... 221
Airbag system............................................ 22 storing radio stations.......................... 244
Bi-Xenon headlights.................................. 63
subwoofer........................................... 242
Air conditioning.......................................... 92 Black Box (Vehicle Event Data)............... 210
USB/iPOD connector.......................... 241
Air distribution table................................. 101 Blind Spot Information System (BLIS)..... 164
Auto-dim rearview mirror........................... 78
Air vents..................................................... 94 Booster cushion
Autolock..................................................... 83
Alarm system........................................... 130 accessory............................................. 42
Automatic locking retractor....................... 36
turning off sensors.............................. 131 Brake fluid........................................ 219, 267
Automatic sound control......................... 243
All Wheel Drive......................................... 152 Brake lights................................................ 64
Automatic transmission........................... 149
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)................. 153 Brake system
kickdown............................................ 150
Approach lighting....................................... 84 oil........................................................ 267 anti-lock brakes (ABS)........................ 153
Audio files................................................ 250 shiftlock override................................ 151 emergency brake assistance.............. 154

Automatic transmission - Geartronic....... 150

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

276
12 Index

fluid..................................................... 219 ISOFIX/LATCH anchors........................ 43 Coolant.................................................... 267


general information............................. 153 top tether anchors................................ 45 changing............................................. 218
Bulbs Child safety................................................ 35 checking level of................................. 218
headlights........................................... 223 booster cushions.................................. 42 Courtesy lighting...................................... 107
list of................................................... 272 child restraint systems.......................... 37 Crash mode............................................... 34
Bulbs, replacing....................................... 223 convertible seats.................................. 40
Cruise control............................................ 70
infant seats........................................... 38
Cup holders..................................... 109, 111
Child safety locks.................................... 129
Curb weight..................................... 183, 265
C Climate system
12
air distribution..................................... 101
Capacities, fluids..................................... 267 air vents................................................ 94
Capacity weight............................... 183, 265 Electronic Climate Control.................... 98 D
Catalytic converter, three-way................. 274 manual climate control......................... 95
Detachable key blade.............................. 120
passenger compartment filter.............. 92
CD changer.............................................. 249 Detachable trailer hitch............................ 162
refrigerant..................................... 92, 267
CD player................................................. 249 Dimensions.............................................. 264
Climate system, general information......... 92
Cell phone, hands-free connection......... 254 Disabling the passenger's side front air-
Clock
Central locking system - remote control. 118 setting................................................... 83 bag............................................................. 26
Chains...................................................... 186 Coat hanger............................................. 110 Disconnecting the front passengers air-
Changing a wheel.................................... 190 bag............................................................. 26
Cold weather precautions........................ 137
Child restraints Display....................................................... 60
Compact disc care.................................. 251
recalls and registration......................... 46 Dolby Pro Logic II (DPL II)........................ 243
Compass in rearview mirror....................... 78
Child restraint systems.............................. 37 Door mirrors............................................... 79
Conserving electrical current................... 138
booster cushions.................................. 42 Driving economically................................ 136
convertible seats.................................. 40 Convertible seats....................................... 40
Driving through water.............................. 137
infant seats........................................... 38

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

277
12 Index

DSTC, stability system............................. 155 Engine oil................................................. 216 manually operated.............................. 104
changing............................................. 216 power.................................................. 105
checking............................................. 216 Fuel filler door
specifications...................................... 269
E volumes.............................................. 267
unlocking.............................................. 65
Fuel gauge................................................. 53
Economical driving.................................. 136 Equalizer, audio system........................... 243
Fuel requirements.................................... 140
Electrical current conserving................ 138 Eyelets for anchoring loads..................... 115
Fuel tank volume...................................... 267
Electrically operated moonroof.................. 81
Fuses, replacing....................................... 230
Electrical system...................................... 272
12
Electronic Brake Force Distribution F
(EBD)........................................................ 154
Federal Clean Air Act............................... 210 G
Electronic Climate Control......................... 93
Flat tires
air distribution table............................ 101 Gasoline requirements............................. 140
changing............................................. 190
Electronic Climate Control (ECC) - option. 98 repairing with tire sealing system....... 192 Geartronic................................................ 150
Emergency brake....................................... 75 Fluids and oils.......................................... 267 Generator................................................. 272
Emergency locking retractor...................... 36 FM1/FM2 menu....................................... 244 Glossary of tire terminology..................... 182
Emergency starting.................................. 159 Fog lights Glove compartment................................. 110
Emergency towing................................... 157 front...................................................... 64 locking................................................ 128

Emission inspection readiness................ 212 rear........................................................ 64 Gross vehicle weight (GVW)............ 183, 265

Engine Front airbags.............................................. 22


specifications...................................... 270 disconnecting passengers side airbag 26
starting................................................ 144 Front fog lights........................................... 64
starting with keyless drive.................. 146 Front park assist...................................... 168
Engine compartment overview................ 215 Front seats............................................... 104
folding backrests................................ 104

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

278
12 Index

H Infant seats................................................ 38 K
Inflatable Curtain........................................ 30
Hand brake (parking brake)....................... 75 Key blade......................................... 120, 124
Inflation pressure..................................... 176
Hands-free connection (cell phone) (Cell Keyless drive
Inflation pressure, checking..................... 177
phone, hands-free connection)................ 254 location of antennas (pacemaker warn-
Inflation pressure table ing)...................................................... 125
Hazard warning flashers............................ 74
Canadian models................................ 179 locking and unlocking the vehicle...... 123
Headlights.................................................. 63 US models.......................................... 178 power seat memory............................ 124
Active Bi-Xenon (option)....................... 63
Information display.............................. 53, 60 starting the engine.............................. 146
changing bulbs................................... 223
messages in.......................................... 60 Keylock.................................................... 144 12
high and low beams............................. 66
high beam flash.................................... 66 Information symbol.................................... 55 Kickdown................................................. 150
Headlight washers..................................... 72 Inspection, preparing for......................... 212
Head restraints, rear seat........................ 113 Inspection readiness................................ 212
High beam flash......................................... 66 Instrument overview.................................. 50 L
High beams................................................ 66 Instrument panel.................................. 50, 53 Label information..................................... 262
Home safe lighting............................... 66, 84 Instrument panel lighting........................... 64 LATCH (ISOFIX) anchors........................... 43
Hood, opening......................................... 214 Interior lighting......................................... 107 Lighting panel............................................ 63
iPOD connector (audio system)............... 241 Load anchoring eyelets........................... 115
ISOFIX/LATCH anchors............................. 43 Loading the vehicle
I roof loads............................................ 163

Ignition switch.......................................... 143 Locking


J from the inside.................................... 127
Immobilizer.............................................. 144
glove compartment............................. 128
Immobilizer (start inhibitor)...................... 118 Jacket hanger.......................................... 110
Locking the vehicle.................................. 123
Indicator and warning symbols............ 53, 55 Jump starting........................................... 159
Locks, child safety................................... 129

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

279
12 Index

Long distance trips.................................. 138 On Call Roadside Assistance.................. 275 R


Lug nuts (wheel nuts)............................... 188 Opening the hood.................................... 214
Radio
Opening the trunk from the inside........... 127
Sirius satellite radio............................ 245
Owner maintenance................................. 212
Radio functions........................................ 244
M
Rain sensor - windshield wipers................ 73
Maintenance............................................ 210
Rear fog light............................................. 64
performed by the owner..................... 212 P
Rear park assist....................................... 168
Manual climate control.............................. 95 Panel lighting, instrument.......................... 64
12 Rear seat backrests, folding down.......... 113
Manual transmission........................ 147, 148 Park assist............................................... 168
Rear seats
Mirrors.................................................. 78, 79 Parking brake............................................. 75 center head restraint........................... 113
Model plate.............................................. 263 Parking lights............................................. 63 Rearview mirror.......................................... 78
Moonroof................................................... 81 Passengers side front airbag, disabling. . . 26 auto-dim function................................. 78
Motor oil........................................... 216, 269 Periodic owner-performed maintenance. 212 Rearview mirror with compass (option)..... 78
checking............................................. 216
Permissible axle weight........................... 183 Recalls, child restraints.............................. 46
Personal settings....................................... 83 Refrigerant (A/C system).................... 92, 267
Power door mirrors.................................... 79 Refueling.................................................. 142
O fuel tank volume................................. 267
Power front seat...................................... 105
Occupant safety........................................ 16 memory function................................. 105 Registering child restraints........................ 46
Occupant weight sensor............................ 26 Power moonroof........................................ 81 Remote control........................................ 118
Octane recommendations....................... 140 Power steering fluid................................. 219 battery replacement............................ 120
functions............................................. 118
Oil............................................................. 216 Power windows......................................... 76
key blade............................................ 120
changing............................................. 216
Pregnancy, using seat belts during........... 19
checking............................................. 216 Replacing fuses....................................... 230
Private locking......................................... 122

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

280
12 Index

Reporting safety defects Shiftlock Sunroof (moonroof).................................... 81


Canada................................................. 17 override............................................... 151 Supplemental restraint system.................. 21
USA....................................................... 16 Side door mirrors....................................... 79
Roof loads................................................ 163 Side impact airbags................................... 29
Rotating tires........................................... 189 Side impact protection (SIPS) airbags....... 29 T
Sirius satellite radio.................................. 245 Tachometer................................................ 53
Snow chains............................................ 186
S Telephone (cellular), hands-free connec-
Snow tires................................................ 186 tion (Cell phone, hands-free connection). 254
Safety, occupant........................................ 16 12
Sound control, automatic........................ 243 Temporary spare tire............................... 187
Safety defects, reporting Sound settings, audio system................. 242 Three-way catalytic converter................. 274
Canada................................................. 17
Spare tire................................................. 187 Tire inflation............................................. 176
USA....................................................... 16
Stability system........................................ 155 Tire inflation pressure
Safety locks, child.................................... 129
Dynamic Stability Traction Control Canadian models................................ 179
Seat belt (DSTC)................................................ 155 US models.......................................... 178
reminder................................................ 19
Starting the engine................................... 144 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) 197
Seat belts................................................... 18 with keyless drive............................... 146 Tires......................................................... 174
Automatic locking retractor/Emergency
Start inhibitor (immobilizer).............. 118, 144 age...................................................... 175
locking retractor.................................... 36
STC, stability system............................... 155 changing............................................. 190
buckling................................................ 18
changing from summer to winter........ 189
maintenance......................................... 20 Steering wheel
designations....................................... 180
pretensioners........................................ 18 adjusting............................................... 74
glossary of terms................................ 182
unbuckling............................................ 18 keypad................................................ 241
improving economy............................ 175
use during pregnancy........................... 19 Storage compartments............................ 109 inflation............................................... 176
Seats, front.............................................. 104 Studded tires........................................... 186 inflation pressure, checking................ 177
Subwoofer............................................... 242

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

281
12 Index

inflation pressure table, Canadian mod- Transmission Vehicle maintenance


els....................................................... 179 Geartronic........................................... 150 performed by the owner..................... 212
inflation pressure table, US models.... 178 manual........................................ 147, 148 Vehicle towing.......................................... 157
load ratings......................................... 177 shiftlock override................................ 151
Vehicle weights........................................ 265
rotation............................................... 189 Tread wear indicator................................ 175
snow................................................... 186 VIN (Vehicle Identification Number)......... 263
Treble....................................................... 242
spare................................................... 187 Volvo Inflatable Curtain.............................. 30
speed ratings...................................... 177 Trip computer............................................ 68
Volvo On Call Roadside Assistance........ 275
storing................................................. 174 Trips, long distance................................. 138
12
studded............................................... 186 Trunk
tire pressure monitoring system......... 197 opening from the inside...................... 127
tire sealing system.............................. 192 W
Turn signals............................................... 66
tread wear indicator............................ 175
indicator lights...................................... 53 Warning flashers, hazard........................... 74
uniform tire quality grading................. 185
winter driving...................................... 186 Warning symbol......................................... 55

Tire sealing system.................................. 192 Warranties................................................ 210

Top tether anchors (child restraint sys-


U Washer fluid..................................... 218, 267
tems).......................................................... 45 Uniform Tire Quality Grading................... 185 Washer fluid reservoir...................... 215, 218
Towing a trailer........................................ 160 Water, driving through............................. 137
trailer hitch.......................................... 162 Weights.................................................... 265
Towing the vehicle................................... 157 V Wheel nuts............................................... 188
Trailer hitch - detachable......................... 162 Wheels..................................................... 174
Valet locking............................................ 122
Trailer towing........................................... 160 changing............................................. 190
Vehicle dimensions.................................. 264
storing................................................. 174
Vehicle Event Data................................... 210
Whiplash Protection System (WHIPS)....... 32
Vehicle loading......................................... 183
roof loads............................................ 163

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

282
12 Index

Windows
power.................................................... 76
Windshield washer fluid reservoir............ 215
Windshield wiper blades.......................... 220
Windshield wipers...................................... 72
rains sensor.......................................... 73
Winter tires............................................... 186
Wiper blades
replacing windshield wipers............... 220 12

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

283
12 Index

12

I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

284
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:
Kdakd8Vg8dgedgVi^dcIE&%''&JH68VcVYV!6I%-'%!Eg^ciZY^cHlZYZc!<iZWdg\'%%-!8deng^\]i'%%%"'%%-Kdakd8Vg8dgedgVi^dc
I
nfor
mat
ionPr
ovi
dedby
:

Você também pode gostar